One document matched: draft-ietf-trade-iotp-v1.0-protocol-03.txt
Differences from draft-ietf-trade-iotp-v1.0-protocol-02.txt
TRADE Working Group David Burdett
Internet Draft Mondex International
draft-ietf-trade-iotp-v1.0-protocol-03.txt
Expires: 28 August 1999
Internet Open Trading Protocol - IOTP
Version 1.0
David Burdett et al. [Page 1]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Status of this Memo
This document is an Internet-Draft and is in full conformance with all
provisions of Section 10 of RFC2026.
Internet-Drafts are working documents of the Internet Engineering Task
Force (IETF), its areas, and its working groups. Note that other
groups may also distribute working documents as Internet-Drafts.
Internet-Drafts are draft documents valid for a maximum of six months
and may be updated, replaced, or obsoleted by other documents at any
time. It is inappropriate to use Internet-Drafts as reference
material or to cite them other than as "work in progress."
To view the list Internet-Draft Shadow Directories, see
http://www.ietf.org/shadow.html.
Distribution of this document is unlimited. Please send comments to
the TRADE working group at <ietf-trade@lists.elistx.com >, which may
be joined by sending a message with subject "subscribe" to <ietf-
trade-request@lists.elistx.com>.
Discussions of the TRADE working group are archived at
http://www.elistx.com/archives/ietf-trade.
David Burdett et al. [Page 2]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Abstract
The Internet Open Trading Protocol (IOTP) provides an interoperable
framework for Internet commerce. It is payment system independent and
encapsulates payment systems such as SET, Mondex, CyberCash, DigiCash,
GeldKarte, etc. IOTP is able to handle cases where such merchant roles
as the shopping site, the payment handler, the Delivery Handler of
goods or services, and the provider of customer support are performed
by different parties or by one party.
David Burdett et al. [Page 3]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Table of Contents
Status of this Memo..................................................2
Abstract.............................................................3
1. Background.......................................................10
1.1 Commerce on the Internet _ a Different Model.................11
1.2 Benefits of IOTP.............................................12
1.3 Baseline IOTP................................................13
1.4 Objectives of Document.......................................14
1.5 Purpose......................................................14
1.6 Scope of Document............................................14
1.7 Document Structure...........................................15
1.8 Intended Readership..........................................16
1.8.1 Reading Guidelines ......................................17
1.9 History......................................................17
2. Introduction.....................................................19
2.1 Trading Roles................................................20
2.2 Trading Exchanges............................................21
2.2.1 Offer Exchange ..........................................23
2.2.2 Payment Exchange ........................................25
2.2.3 Delivery Exchange .......................................29
2.2.4 Authentication Exchange .................................31
2.3 Scope of Baseline IOTP.......................................33
3. Protocol Structure...............................................38
3.1 Overview.....................................................40
3.1.1 IOTP Message Structure ..................................40
3.1.2 IOTP Transactions .......................................42
3.2 IOTP Message.................................................43
3.2.1 XML Document Prolog .....................................45
3.3 Transaction Reference Block..................................45
3.3.1 Transaction Id Component ................................46
3.3.2 Message Id Component ....................................48
3.3.3 Related To Component ....................................49
3.4 ID Attributes................................................51
3.4.1 IOTP Message ID Attribute Definition ....................52
3.4.2 Block and Component ID Attribute Definitions ............53
3.4.3 Example of use of ID Attributes .........................54
3.5 Element References...........................................55
3.6 Brands and Brand Selection...................................56
3.6.1 Definition of Payment Instrument ........................57
3.6.2 Definition of Brand .....................................58
3.6.3 Definition of Dual Brand ................................58
David Burdett et al. [Page 4]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.6.4 Definition of Promotional Brand .........................59
3.6.5 Identifying Promotional Brands ..........................59
3.7 Extending IOTP...............................................62
3.7.1 Extra XML Elements ......................................62
3.7.2 Opaque Embedded Data ....................................63
3.7.3 Values for IOTP Codes ...................................63
3.8 Packaged Content Element.....................................66
3.8.1 Packaging HTML ..........................................68
3.9 Identifying Languages........................................69
3.10 Secure and Insecure Net Locations...........................70
3.11 Cancelled Transactions......................................70
3.11.1 Cancelling Transactions ................................70
3.11.2 Handling Cancelled Transactions ........................71
4. IOTP Error Handling..............................................73
4.1 Technical Errors.............................................73
4.2 Business Errors..............................................74
4.3 Error Depth..................................................74
4.3.1 Transport Level .........................................75
4.3.2 Message Level ...........................................75
4.3.3 Block Level .............................................76
4.4 Idempotency, Processing Sequence, and Message Flow...........78
4.4.1 Server Role Processing Sequence .........................78
4.4.2 Client Role Processing Sequence .........................84
5. Security Considerations..........................................90
5.1 Digital Signatures and IOTP..................................90
5.1.1 IOTP Signature Example ..................................92
5.1.2 OriginatorInfo and RecipientInfo Elements ...............94
5.1.3 Symmetric and Asymmetric Cryptography ...................95
5.1.4 Mandatory and Optional Signatures .......................95
5.1.5 Using signatures to Prove Actions Complete Successfully .95
5.2 Checking a Signature is Correctly Calculated.................96
5.3 Checking a Payment or Delivery can occur.....................97
5.3.1 Check the Action Request was sent to the Correct
Organisation ..................................................99
5.3.2 Check the Correct Components are present in the Request
Block ........................................................103
5.3.3 Check an Action is Authorised ..........................103
5.4 Data Integrity and Privacy..................................105
6. Trading Components..............................................106
6.1 Protocol Options Component..................................108
6.2 Authentication Data Component...............................110
6.3 Authentication Response Component...........................112
6.4 Order Component.............................................113
6.4.1 Order Description Content ..............................115
David Burdett et al. [Page 5]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.4.2 OkFrom and OkTo Timestamps .............................115
6.5 Organisation Component......................................116
6.5.2 Trading Role Element ...................................119
6.5.3 Contact Information Element ............................122
6.5.4 Person Name Element ....................................123
6.5.5 Postal Address Element .................................124
6.6 Brand List Component........................................125
6.6.1 Brand Element ..........................................127
6.6.2 Protocol Amount Element ................................130
6.6.3 Currency Amount Element ................................132
6.6.4 Pay Protocol Element ...................................133
6.7 Brand Selection Component...................................135
6.7.1 Brand Selection Brand Info Element .....................137
6.7.2 Brand Selection Protocol Amount Info Element ...........138
6.7.3 Brand Selection Currency Amount Info Element ...........138
6.8 Payment Component...........................................139
6.9 Payment Scheme Component....................................141
6.10 Payment Receipt Component..................................142
6.11 Payment Note Component.....................................144
6.12 Delivery Component.........................................145
6.12.1 Delivery Data Element .................................147
6.13 Delivery Note Component....................................149
6.14 Status Component...........................................151
6.14.1 Offer Completion Codes ................................154
6.14.2 Payment Completion Codes ..............................154
6.14.3 Delivery Completion Codes .............................155
6.14.4 Authentication Completion Codes .......................157
6.15 Trading Role Data Component................................158
6.15.1 Who Receives a Trading Role Data Component ............159
6.16 Inquiry Type Component.....................................159
6.17 Signature Component........................................160
6.17.1 IOTP usage of signature elements and attributes .......164
6.17.2 Offer Response Signature Component ....................166
6.17.3 Payment Receipt Signature Component ...................167
6.17.4 Delivery Response Signature Component .................168
6.17.5 Authentication Request Signature Component ............168
6.17.6 Authentication Response Signature Component ...........168
6.17.7 Ping Request Signature Component ......................169
6.17.8 Ping Response Signature Component .....................169
6.18 Certificate Component......................................169
6.18.1 IOTP usage of signature elements and attributes .......170
6.19 Error Component............................................170
6.19.1 Error Processing Guidelines ...........................173
6.19.2 Error Codes ...........................................174
6.19.3 Error Location Element ................................178
7. Trading Blocks..................................................180
David Burdett et al. [Page 6]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
7.1 Trading Protocol Options Block..............................183
7.2 TPO Selection Block.........................................184
7.3 Offer Response Block........................................185
7.4 Authentication Request Block................................186
7.5 Authentication Response Block...............................187
7.6 Authentication Status Block.................................187
7.7 Payment Request Block.......................................188
7.8 Payment Exchange Block......................................190
7.9 Payment Response Block......................................190
7.10 Delivery Request Block.....................................191
7.11 Delivery Response Block....................................193
7.12 Inquiry Request Trading Block..............................194
7.13 Inquiry Response Trading Block.............................194
7.14 Ping Request Block.........................................195
7.15 Ping Response Block........................................196
7.16 Signature Block............................................198
7.16.1 Offer Response ........................................199
7.16.2 Payment Request .......................................199
7.16.3 Payment Response ......................................199
7.16.4 Delivery Request ......................................199
7.17 Error Block................................................199
7.18 Cancel Block...............................................201
8. Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions.....................202
8.1 Authentication and Payment Related IOTP Transactions........202
8.1.1 Authentication Document Exchange .......................205
8.1.2 Offer Document Exchange ................................212
8.1.3 Payment Document Exchange ..............................222
8.1.4 Delivery Document Exchange .............................228
8.1.5 Payment and Delivery Document Exchange .................231
8.1.6 Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction ...............234
8.1.7 Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction ......................236
8.1.8 Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction .....................238
8.1.9 Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction .......................240
8.1.10 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction ..................242
8.1.11 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction ..............244
8.1.12 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges ..............248
8.1.13 Combining Authentication Transactions with other
Transactions .................................................252
8.2 Infrastructure Transactions.................................253
8.2.1 Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry IOTP Transaction ...254
8.2.2 Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction .........................258
9. Retrieving Logos................................................262
9.1 Logo Size...................................................262
9.2 Logo Color Depth............................................263
9.3 Logo Net Location Examples..................................263
David Burdett et al. [Page 7]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
10. Brand List Examples............................................265
10.1 Simple Credit Card Based Example...........................265
10.2 Credit Card Brand List Including Promotional Brands........266
10.3 Brand Selection Example....................................269
10.4 Complex Electronic Cash Based Brand List...................269
11. Open Trading Protocol Data Type Definition.....................274
12. Glossary.......................................................289
13. Copyrights.....................................................298
14. References.....................................................299
15. Author's Address...............................................303
David Burdett et al. [Page 8]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Table of Figures
Figure 1 IOTP Trading Roles ........................................20
Figure 2 Offer Exchange ............................................23
Figure 3 Payment Exchange ..........................................26
Figure 4 Delivery Exchange .........................................30
Figure 5 Authentication Exchange ...................................33
Figure 6 IOTP Message Structure ....................................41
Figure 7 An IOTP Transaction .......................................42
Figure 8 Example use of ID attributes ..............................54
Figure 9 Element References ........................................56
Figure 10 Server Role Processing Sequence ..........................80
Figure 11 Client Role Processing Sequence ..........................86
Figure 12 Signature Digests ........................................91
Figure 13 Example use of Signatures for Baseline Purchase ..........93
Figure 14 Checking a Payment Handler can carry out a Payment ......100
Figure 15 Checking a Delivery Handler can carry out a Delivery ....102
Figure 16 Trading Components ......................................107
Figure 17 Brand List Element Relationships ........................127
Figure 18 Trading Blocks ..........................................181
Figure 19 Payment and Authentication Message Flow Combinations ....204
Figure 20 Authentication Document Exchange ........................208
Figure 21 Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange .................214
Figure 22 Brand Independent Offer Exchange ........................217
Figure 23 Payment Document Exchange ...............................224
Figure 24 Delivery Document Exchange ..............................229
Figure 25 Payment and Delivery Document Exchange ..................232
Figure 26 Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction ................235
Figure 27 Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction .......................237
Figure 28 Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction ......................239
Figure 29 Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction ........................241
Figure 30 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction ....................243
Figure 31 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction ................246
Figure 32 Baseline Value Exchange Signatures ......................247
Figure 33 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges ................250
Figure 34 Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry .....................257
Figure 35 Baseline Ping Messages ..................................259
David Burdett et al. [Page 9]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
1. Background
The Internet Open Trading Protocol (IOTP) provides an interoperable
framework for Internet commerce. It is payment system independent and
encapsulates payment systems such as SET, Mondex, CyberCash, DigiCash,
GeldKarte, etc. IOTP is able to handle cases where such merchant roles
as the shopping site, the payment handler, the Delivery Handler of
goods or services, and the provider of customer support are performed
by different parties or by one party.
The developers of IOTP seek to provide a virtual capability that
safely replicates the real world, the paper based, traditional,
understood, accepted methods of trading, buying, selling, value
exchanging that has existed for many hundreds of years. The
negotiation of who will be the parties to the trade, how it will be
conducted, the presentment of an offer, the method of payment, the
provision of a payment receipt, the delivery of goods and the receipt
of goods. These are events that are taken for granted in the course of
real world trade. IOTP has been produced to provide the same for the
virtual world, and to prepare and provide for the introduction of new
models of trading made possible by the expanding presence of the
virtual world.
The other fundamental ideal of the IOTP effort is to produce a
definition of these trading events in such a way that no matter where
produced, two unfamiliar parties using electronic commerce
capabilities to buy and sell that conform to the IOTP specifications
will be able to complete the business safely and successfully.
In summary, IOTP supports:
o Familiar trading models
o New trading models
o Global interoperability
The remainder of this section provides background to why IOTP was
developed. The specification itself starts in the next chapter.
David Burdett et al. [Page 10]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
1.1 Commerce on the Internet _ a Different Model
The growth of the Internet and the advent of electronic commerce are
bringing about enormous changes around the world in society, politics
and government, and in business. The ways in which trading partners
communicate, conduct commerce, are governed have been enriched and
changed forever.
One of the very fundamental changes about which IOTP is concerned is
taking place in the way consumers and merchants trade. Characteristics
of trading that have changed markedly include:
o Presence: Face-to-face transactions become the exception, not
the rule. Already with the rise of mail order and telephone
order placement this change has been felt in western commerce.
Electronic commerce over the Internet will further expand the
scope and volume of transactions conducted without ever seeing
the people who are a part of the enterprise with whom one does
business.
o Authentication: An important part of personal presence is the
ability of the parties to use familiar objects and dialogue to
confirm they are who they claim to be. The seller displays one
or several well known financial logos that declaim his ability
to accept widely used credit and debit instruments in the
payment part of a purchase. The buyer brings government or
financial institution identification that assures the seller
she will be paid. People use intangibles such as personal
appearance and conduct, location of the store, apparent quality
and familiarity with brands of merchandise, and a good clear
look in the eye to reinforce formal means of authentication.
o Payment Instruments: Despite the enormous size of bank card
financial payments associations and their members, most of the
world's trade still takes place using the coin of the realm or
barter. The present infrastructure of the payments business
cannot economically support low value transactions and could
not survive under the consequent volumes of transactions if it
did accept low value transactions.
o Transaction Values: New meaning for low value transactions
arises in the Internet where sellers may wish to offer for
example, pages of information for fractions of currency that do
not exist in the real world.
o Delivery: New modes of delivery must be accommodated such as
direct electronic delivery. The means by which receipt is
David Burdett et al. [Page 11]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
confirmed and the execution of payment change dramatically
where the goods or services have extremely low delivery cost
but may in fact have very high value. Or, maybe the value is
not high, but once delivery occurs the value is irretrievably
delivered so payment must be final and non-refundable but
delivery nonetheless must still be confirmed before payment.
Incremental delivery such as listening or viewing time or
playing time are other models that operate somewhat differently
in the virtual world.
1.2 Benefits of IOTP
ELECTRONIC COMMERCE SOFTWARE VENDORS
Electronic Commerce Software Vendors will be able to develop e-
commerce products which are more attractive as they will inter-operate
with any other vendors' software. However since IOTP focuses on how
these solutions communicate, there is still plenty of opportunity for
product differentiation.
PAYMENT BRANDS
IOTP provides a standard framework for encapsulating payment
protocols. This means that it is easier for payment products to be
incorporated into IOTP solutions. As a result the payment brands will
be more widely distributed and available on a wider variety of
platforms.
MERCHANTS
There are several benefits for Merchants:
o they will be able to offer a wider variety of payment brands,
o they can be more certain that the customer will have the
software needed to complete the purchase
o through receiving payment and delivery receipts from their
customers, they will be able to provide customer care knowing
that they are dealing with the individual or organisation with
which they originally traded
o new merchants will be able to enter this new (Internet) market-
place with new products and services, using the new trading
opportunities which IOTP presents
David Burdett et al. [Page 12]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
BANKS AND FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS
There are also several benefits for Banks and Financial Institutions:
o they will be able to provide IOTP support for merchants
o they will find new opportunities for IOTP related services:
- providing customer care for merchants
- fees from processing new payments and deposits
o they have an opportunity to build relationships with new types
of merchants
CUSTOMERS
For Customers there are several benefits:
o they will have a larger selection of merchants with whom they
can trade
o there is a more consistent interface when making the purchase
o there are ways in which they can get their problems fixed
through the merchant (rather than the bank!)
o there is a record of their transaction which can be used, for
example, to feed into accounting systems or, potentially, to
present to the tax authorities
1.3 Baseline IOTP
This specification is Baseline IOTP. It is a Baseline in that it
contains ways of doing trades on the Internet which are the most
common. The team working on the IOTP see an extended versions of this
specification being developed as needs demand but at this stage feel a
need to develop a limited function but usable specification in order
that technology providers can develop pathway-pilot products that will
be placed in the market in order to understand the real _market place_
demands and requirements for electronic trading or electronic
commerce. To proceed otherwise would be presumptuous, time consuming,
expensive and foolish.
Accordingly the IOTP Baseline specification has been produced for
pathway-pilot product development, expecting to transact live trades
David Burdett et al. [Page 13]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
to prove the interoperability of solutions based on this specification
by end '98.
During this period it is anticipated that there will be no changes to
the scope of this specification with the only changes made being
limited to corrections where problems are found. Software solutions
have been developed based on earlier versions of this specification
which prove that the basic concepts work.
1.4 Objectives of Document
The objectives of this document are to provide a functional
specification of version 1.0 of the Open Trading Protocols which can
be used to design and implement systems which support electronic
trading on the Internet using the Open Trading Protocols.
An overview of IOTP is provided the IOTP Business Description which
explains the Business Requirements for IOTP.
1.5 Purpose
The purpose of the document is:
o to allow potential developers of products based on the protocol
to start development of software/hardware solutions which use
the protocol
o to allow the financial services industry to understand a
developing electronic commerce trading protocol that
encapsulates (without modification) any of the current or
developing payment schemes now being used or considered by
their merchant customer base
1.6 Scope of Document
The protocol describes the content, format and sequences of messages
that pass among the participants in an electronic trade - consumers,
merchants and banks or other financial institutions, and customer care
providers. These are required to support the electronic commerce
transactions outlined in the objectives above.
David Burdett et al. [Page 14]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The protocol is designed to be applicable to any electronic payment
scheme since it targets the complete purchase process where the
movement of electronic value from the payer to the payee is only one,
but important, step of many that may be involved to complete the
trade.
Payment Scheme which IOTP could support include MasterCard Credit,
Visa Credit, Mondex Cash, Visa Cash, GeldKarte, DigiCash, CyberCoin,
Millicent, Proton etc.
Each payment scheme contains some message flows which are specific to
that scheme. These scheme-specific parts of the protocol are contained
in a set of payment scheme supplements to this specification.
The document does not prescribe the software and processes that will
need to be implemented by each participant. It does describe the
framework necessary for trading to take place.
This document also does not address any legal or regulatory issues
surrounding the implementation of the protocol or the information
systems which use them.
1.7 Document Structure
The document consists of the following sections:
o Section 1 - Background: This section gives a brief background
on electronic commerce and the benefits IOTP offers.
o Section 2 - Introduction: This section describes the various
Trading Exchanges and shows how these trading exchanges are
used to construct the IOTP Transactions. This section also
explains various Trading Roles that would participate in
electronic trade.
o Section 3 - Protocol Structure: This section summarises how
various IOTP transactions are constructed using the Trading
Blocks and Trading Components that are the fundamental building
blocks for IOTP transactions. All IOTP transaction messages are
well formed XML documents.
o Section 4 - IOTP Error Handling: This section describes how to
process exceptions and errors during the protocol message
exchange and trading exchange processing. This section provides
David Burdett et al. [Page 15]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
a generic overview of the exception handling. This section
should be read carefully.
o Section 5 - Security Considerations: This section describes
security considerations and digital signatures for the XML
elements exchanged between the Trading Roles.
o Section 6 - Trading Components: This section defines the XML
elements required by Trading Components.
o Section 7 - Trading Blocks: This section describes how Trading
Blocks are constructed from Trading Components.
o Section 8 - Open Trading Protocol Transactions: This section
describes all the IOTP Baseline transactions. It refers to
Trading Blocks and Trading Components and Signatures. This
section doesn't directly link error handling during the
protocol exchanges, the reader is advised to understand Error
Handling as defined in section before reading this section.
o Section 9 - Retrieving Logos: This section describes how IOTP
specific logos can be retrieved.
o Section 10 - Brand List Examples: This section gives some
examples for Brand List.
o Section 11 - XML Overview: This section gives brief
introduction to XML.
o Section 12 - Open Trading Protocol Data Type Definition: This
section contains the XML Data Type Definitions for IOTP.
o Section 12 - Glossary. This describes all the major terminology
used by IOTP.
1.8 Intended Readership
Software and hardware developers; development analysts; business and
technical planners; industry analysts; merchants; bank and other
payment handlers; owners, custodians, and users of payment protocols.
David Burdett et al. [Page 16]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
1.8.1 Reading Guidelines
This IOTP specification is structured primarily in a sequence targeted
at people who want to understand the principles of IOTP. However from
practical implementation experience by implementers of earlier of
versions of the protocol new readers who plan to implement IOTP may
prefer to read the document in a different sequence as described
below.
Review the transport independent parts of the specification: This
covers
o Section 12 - Glossary
o Section 1 - Background
o Section 2 - Introduction
o Section 3 - Protocol Structure
o Section 4 - IOTP Error Handling
o Section 8 - Open Trading Protocol Transactions
o Section 10 - Brand List Examples
o Section 4 - IOTP Error Handling
o Section 9 - Retrieving Logos
Review the detailed XML definitions:
o Section 11 - XML Overview (if the reader does not know XML)
o Section 7 - Trading Blocks
o Section 6 - Trading Components
1.9 History
Version 0.1 20 February 1997 Initial draft for comment
Version 0.2 14 April 1997 Revised draft including changes
arising from comments
David Burdett et al. [Page 17]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Version 0.2a 24 April 1997 Same as version 0-2 with
typographic corrections
Version 0.3 9 October 1997 Revised draft for comment
including revised encoding
approach using [XML]
Version 0.4 31 October 1997 Published draft for limited public
review by groups working within
the OTP consortium
Version 0.9 12 January 1998 Revisions following limited public
review _ draft for public comment
only.
Version 0.9.1 20 May 1998 Revisions following public review
- internal IOTP Consortium review.
Version 0.9.9 17 August 1998 Draft published for submission to
IETF for information.
Version 1.0 23 October 1998 Draft published incorporating
comments received on version
0.9.9.
Version 1.0 28 February 1998 Revised draft published incorporating
comments received on version 1.0
David Burdett et al. [Page 18]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
2. Introduction
The Internet Open Trading Protocols (IOTP) define a number of
different types of IOTP Transactions:
o Purchase. This supports a purchase involving an offer, a
payment and optionally a delivery
o Refund. This supports the refund of a payment as a result of,
typically, an earlier purchase
o Value Exchange. This involves two payments which result in the
exchange of value from one combination of currency and payment
method to another
o Authentication. This supports one organisation or individual to
check that another organisation or individual are who they
appear to be.
o Withdrawal. This supports the withdrawal of electronic cash
from a financial institution
o Deposit. This supports the deposit of electronic cash at a
financial institution
o Inquiry This supports inquiries on the status of an IOTP
transaction which is either in progress or is complete
o Ping This supports a simple query which enables one IOTP aware
application to determine whether another IOTP application
running elsewhere is working or not.
These IOTP Transactions are "Baseline" transactions since they have
been identified as a minimum useful set of transactions. Later
versions of IOTP may include additional types of transactions.
Each of the IOTP Transactions above involve:
o a number organisations playing a Trading Role, and
o a set of Trading Exchanges. Each Trading Exchange involves the
exchange of data, between Trading Roles, in the form of a set
of Trading Components.
David Burdett et al. [Page 19]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Trading Roles, Trading Exchanges and Trading Components are described
below.
2.1 Trading Roles
The Trading Roles identify the different parts which organisations can
take in a trade. The six Trading Roles used within IOTP are
illustrated in the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Merchant Customer Care Provider resolves ----------
---------------------------------------------->| Merchant |
| Consumer disputes and problems |Cust.Care.|
| | Provider |
| ----------
|
Payment Handler accepts or makes ----------
| ------------------------------------------>| Payment |
| | Payment for Merchant | Handler |
| | ----------
v v
---------- Consumer makes purchases or obtains ----------
| Consumer |<--------------------------------------->| Merchant |
---------- refund from Merchant ----------
^
| Delivery Handler supplies goods or ----------
|---------------------------------------------->|Deliverer |
services for Merchant ----------
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 1 IOTP Trading Roles
The roles are:
o Consumer. The person or organisation which is to receive and
pay for the goods or services
o Merchant. The person or organisation from whom the purchase is
being made and who is legally responsible for providing the
goods or services and receives the benefit of the payment made
o Payment Handler. The entity that physically receives the
payment from the Consumer on behalf of the Merchant
David Burdett et al. [Page 20]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Delivery Handler. The entity that physically delivers the goods
or services to the Consumer on behalf of the Merchant.
o Merchant Customer Care Provider. The entity that is involved
with customer dispute negotiation and resolution on behalf of
the Merchant
Roles may be carried out by the same organisation or different
organisations. For example:
o in the simplest case one physical organisation (e.g. a
merchant) could handle the purchase, accept the payment,
deliver the goods and provide merchant customer care
o at the other extreme, a merchant could handle the purchase but
instruct the consumer to pay a bank or financial institution,
request that delivery be made by an overnight courier firm and
to contact an organisation which provides 24x7 service if
problems arise.
Note that in this specification, unless stated to the contrary, when
the words Consumer, Merchant, Payment Handler, Delivery Handler or
Customer Care Provider are used, they refer to the Trading Role rather
than an actual organisation.
An individual organisation may take multiple roles. For example a
company which is selling goods and services on the Internet could take
the role of Merchant when selling goods or services and the role of
Consumer when the company is buying goods or services itself.
As roles occur in different places there is a need for the
organisations involved in the trade to exchange data, i.e. to carry
out Trading Exchanges, so that the trade can be completed.
2.2 Trading Exchanges
The Open Trading Protocols identify four Trading Exchanges which
involve the exchange of data between the Trading Roles. The Trading
Exchanges are:
o Offer. The Offer Exchange results in the Merchant providing the
Consumer with the reason why the trade is taking place. It is
called an Offer since the Consumer must accept the Offer if a
trade is to continue
David Burdett et al. [Page 21]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Payment. The Payment Exchange results in a payment of some kind
between the Consumer and the Payment Handler. This may occur in
either direction
o Delivery. The Delivery Exchange transmits either the on-line
goods, or delivery information about physical goods from the
Delivery Handler to the Consumer, and
o Authentication. The Authentication Exchange can be used by any
Trading Role to authenticate another Trading Role to check that
they are who they appear to be.
IOTP Transactions are composed of various combinations of these
Trading Exchanges. For example, an IOTP Purchase transaction includes
Offer, Payment, and Delivery Trading Exchanges. As another example,
an IOTP Value Exchange transaction is composed of an Offer Trading
Exchange and two Payment Trading Exchanges.
Trading Exchanges consist of Trading Components that are transmitted
between the various Trading Roles. Where possible, the number of
round-trip delays in an IOTP Transaction is minimised by packing the
Components from several Trading Exchanges into combination IOTP
Messages. For example, the IOTP Purchase transaction combines a
Delivery Organisation Component with an Offer Response Component in
order to avoid an extra Consumer request and response.
Each of the IOTP Trading Exchanges is described in more detail below.
For clarity of description, these describe the Trading Exchanges as
though they were standalone operations. For performance reasons, the
Trading Exchanges are intermingled in the actual IOTP Transaction
definitions.
David Burdett et al. [Page 22]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
2.2.1 Offer Exchange
The goal of the Offer Exchange is for the Merchant to provide the
Consumer with information about the trade so that the Consumer can
decide whether to continue with the trade. This is illustrated in the
figure below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE MERCHANT
1. Consumer decides to ----------------------> 2. Merchant checks
trade and sends Information on what is the information
information about the being purchased (Offer provided by the
transaction (requests Request) (outside scope Consumer, creates an
an offer) to the of IOTP) Offer and sends it
Merchant, e.g using to the Consumer|
HTML
v
3. Consumer checks the Components: Organisation(s)
information from the (Consumer, DeliverTo, Merchant,
Merchant and decides <---------- Payment Handler, Delivery
whether to continue Offer Handler, Cust Care); Order; Pay
Response Amount; Delivery; Signature
(Offer Response)(which signs
other components)
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 2 Offer Exchange
An Offer Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are
passed between the Consumer and the Merchant:
o the Organisation Component contains information which describes
the organisations which are taking a role in the trade:
- the consumer provides information, about who the consumer is and,
if goods or services are being delivered, where the goods or
services are to be delivered to
- the merchant augments this information by providing information
about the merchant, the Payment Handler, the customer care
provider and, if goods or services are being delivered, the
Delivery Handler
o the Order Component contains descriptions of the goods or
services which will result from the trade if the consumer
David Burdett et al. [Page 23]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
agrees to the offer. This information is sent by the Merchant
to the consumer who should verify it
o the Payment Component generated by the Merchant, contains
details of how much to pay, the currency and the payment
direction, for example the consumer could be asking for a
refund. Note that there may be more than one payment in a trade
o the Delivery Component, also generated by the Merchant, is used
if goods or services are being delivered. This contains
information about how delivery will occur, for example by post
or using e-mail
o the "Offer Response" Signature Component, if present, digitally
signs all of the above components to ensure their integrity.
The exact content of the information provided by the Merchant to the
Consumer will vary depending on the type of IOTP Transaction. For
example:
o low value purchases may not need a signature
o the amount to be paid may vary depending on the payment brand
and payment protocol used
o some offers may not involve the delivery of any goods
o a value exchange will involve two payments
o a merchant may not offer customer care.
Information provided by the consumer to the merchant is provided using
a variety of methods, for example, it could be provided:
o using [HTML] pages as part of the "shopping experience" of the
consumer.
o Using the Open Profiling Standard [OPS] which has recently been
proposed,
o in the form of Organisation Components associated with an
authentication of a Consumer by a Merchant
o as Order Components in a later version of IOTP.
David Burdett et al. [Page 24]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
2.2.2 Payment Exchange
The goal of the Payment Exchange is for a payment to be made from the
Consumer to a Payment Handler or vice versa using a payment brand and
payment protocol selected by the Consumer. A secondary goal is to
optionally provide the Consumer with a digitally signed Payment
Receipt which can be used to link the payment to the reason for the
payment as described in the Offer Exchange.
Payment Exchanges can work in a variety of ways. The most general case
where the trade is dependent on the payment brand and protocol used is
illustrated in the diagram below. Simpler payment exchanges are
possible.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE MERCHANT
1. Consumer decides to 2. Merchant decides
trade and sends Information on what is which payment
information about the being paid for brand, payment
transaction (requests an ----------------------> protocols and
offer) to the Merchant, (outside scope of IOTP) currencies/amounts
e.g using HTML to offer, places
them in a Brand
List Component and
sends them to the
Consumer
|
v
3. Consumer selects the payment <----------------- Brand List
brand, protocol and currency/amount Brand List Component
to use, creates a Brand Selection
Component and sends it to the
Merchant
|
v
Brand Selection ----------------> 4. Merchant checks Brand
Brand Selection Selection, creates Payment Amount
information, optionally signs it
to authorise payment and sends it
to the Consumer
|
v
5. Consumer checks the Components:
Payment Amount information <-------- Pay Amount; Auth data;
and if OK requests that the Payment Organisation(s) (Merchant &
payment starts by sending Information Payment Handler); Signature
David Burdett et al. [Page 25]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
information to the Payment (Offer) (signs other
Handler components)
|
| ========================================
v PAYMENT HANDLER
Components: Pay Scheme; Auth 6. Payment Handler checks
Data; Brand List; Pay Amount; information including
Brand Selection; ----------> optional signature and if
Organisation(s) (Merchant & Payment OK starts exchanging Pay
Payment Handler); Signature Request Scheme Components using
(Offer) (signs all other messages for selected
----- components except payment brand and payment
| Pay Scheme) protocol
| | |
| v v
| Component: Pay Scheme <------------------> Component: Pay Scheme
| Payment Exchange
| |
| v
| 7. Eventually payment protocol messages
----------- finish so Payment Handler sends Pay
| Receipt and optional signature to
| Consumer as proof of payment
| |
| v
8. Consumer checks Pay Components: Pay Receipt; Pay
Receipt is OK <------- scheme; Signature (Offer);
Payment Signature (Pay Receipt) (signs Pay
Response Receipt and Signature (Offer)
components)
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 3 Payment Exchange
A Payment Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are
passed between the Consumer, the Merchant and the Payment Handler:
o The Brand List Component contains a list of payment brands (for
example, MasterCard, Visa, Mondex, GeldKarte), payment
protocols (for example SET Version 1.0, Secure Channel Credit
Debit (SCCD - the name used for a credit or debit card payment
where unauthorised access to account information is prevented
through use of secure channel transport mechanisms such as SSL)
as well as currencies/amounts that apply. The Merchant sends
the Brand List to the Consumer. The consumer compares the
David Burdett et al. [Page 26]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
payment brands, protocols and currencies/amounts on offer with
those that the Consumer supports and makes a selection.
o The Brand Selection Component contains the Consumer's
selection. Payment brand, protocol, currency/amount and
possibly protocol-specific information is sent back to the
Merchant. This information may be used to change information in
the Offer Exchange. For example, a merchant could choose to
offer a discount to encourage the use of a store card.
o The Organisation Components are generated by the Merchant. They
contain details of the Merchant and Payment Handler Roles:
- the Merchant role is required so that the Payment Handler can
identify which Merchant initiated the payment. Typically, the
result of the Payment Handler accepting (or making) a payment on
behalf of the Merchant will be a credit or debit transaction to
the Merchant's account held by the Payment Handler. These
transactions are outside the scope of this version of IOTP
- the Payment Handler role is required so that the Payment Handler
can check that it is the correct Payment Handler to be used for
the payment
o The Payment Component contains details of how much to pay, the
currency and the payment direction
o The "Offer Response" Signature Component, if present, digitally
signs all of the above components to ensure their integrity.
Note that the Brand List and Brand Selection Components are not
signed until the payment information is created (step 4 in the
diagram)
o The Payment Scheme Component contains messages from the payment
protocol used in the Trade. For example they could be SET
messages, Mondex messages, GeldKarte Messages or one of the
other payment methods supported by IOTP. The content of the
Payment Scheme Component is defined in the supplements that
describe how IOTP works with various payment protocols.
o The Payment Receipt Component contains a record of the payment.
The content depends upon the payment protocol used.
o The "Payment Receipt" Signature Component provides proof of
payment by digitally signing both the Payment Receipt Component
and the Offer Response Signature. The signature on the offer
digitally signs the Order, Organisation and Delivery Components
contained in the Offer. This signature effectively binds the
payment to the offer.
David Burdett et al. [Page 27]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The example of a Payment Exchange above is the most general case.
Simpler cases are also possible. For example, if the amount paid is
not dependent on the payment brand and protocol selected then the
payment information generated by step 3 can be sent to the Consumer at
the same time as the Brand List Component generated by step 1. These
and other variations are described in the Baseline Purchase IOTP
Transaction (see section Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction).
David Burdett et al. [Page 28]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
2.2.3 Delivery Exchange
The goal of the Delivery Exchange is to cause purchased goods to be
delivered to the consumer either online or via physical delivery. A
second goal is to provide a "delivery note" to the consumer, providing
details about the delivery, such as shipping tracking number. The
result of the delivery may also be signed so that it can be used for
customer care in the case of problems with physical delivery. The
message flow is illustrated in the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE MERCHANT
1. Consumer decides to ------------> 2. Merchant checks the
trade and sends Information information provided by the
information about what on what is Consumer, adds information
to deliver and who is being about how the delivery will
to take delivery, to delivered occur, information about the
the Merchant, using for (outside organisations involved in the
example, HTML scope of delivery and optionally signs
IOTP) it
|
v
3. Consumer checks the Components:
delivery information is OK, Delivery;
obtains authorisation for <----------------- Organisation(s)
the delivery, for example by Delivery Delivery Handler,
making a payment, and sends Information Deliver To; Order;
the delivery information to Signature (Offer)
the Delivery Handler.
|
v
Components: Delivery; 4. Delivery Handler checks
Organisation(s), Merchant, information and
Delivery Handler, DelivTo; --------> authorisation. Starts or
Order; Signature (Offer); Delivery schedules delivery and
Signature (Pay Receipt) Request creates and then sends a
(from Payment Exchange) delivery note to the Consumer
which can optionally be signed
|
v
5. Consumer checks delivery <--------- Component: Delivery
note is OK and accepts or waits Delivery Note; Signature
for delivery as described in Response (Delivery Response)
the Delivery Note
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
David Burdett et al. [Page 29]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Figure 4 Delivery Exchange
A Delivery Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are
passed between the Consumer, the Merchant and the Delivery Handler:
o The Organisation Component(s) contain details of the Deliver
To, Delivery Handler and Merchant Roles:
- the Deliver To role indicates where the goods or services are to
be delivered to
- the Delivery Handler role is required so that the Delivery Handler
can check that she is the correct Delivery Handler to do the
delivery
- the Merchant role is required so that the Delivery Handler can
identify which Merchant initiated the delivery
o The Order Component, contains information about the goods or
services to be delivered
o The Delivery Component contains information about how delivery
will occur, for example by post or using e-mail.
o The "Offer Response" Signature Component, if present, digitally
signs all of the above components to ensure their integrity.
o The "Payment Receipt" Signature Component provides proof of
payment by digitally signing the Payment Receipt Component and
the Offer Signature. This is used by the Delivery Handler to
check that delivery is authorised
o The Delivery Note Component contains customer care information
related to a physical delivery, or alternatively the actual
"electronic goods". The Consumer's software does not interpret
information about a physical delivery but should have the
ability to display the information, both at the time of the
delivery and later if the Consumer selects the Trade to which
this delivery relates from a transaction list
o The "Delivery Response" Signature Component, if present,
provides proof of the results of the Delivery by digitally
signing the Delivery Note and any Offer Response or Payment
Response signatures that the Delivery Handler received.
David Burdett et al. [Page 30]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
2.2.4 Authentication Exchange
The goal of the Authentication Exchange is to allow one organisation,
for example a financial institution, to be able to check that another
organisation, for example a consumer, is who they appear to be. It
uses a "challenge-response" mechanism.
An Authentication Exchange involves:
o an Authenticator - the organisation which is requesting the
authentication, and
o an Authenticatee - the organisation being authenticated.
This is illustrated in the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 31]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
ORGANISATION 1 IOTP MESSAGE ORGANISATION 2
(AUTHENTICATEE) (AUTHENTICATOR)
1. First organisation, 2. The second
e.g a consumer, takes an organisation generates
action (for example by ----------------> Authentication Data
pressing a button on an Need for containing challenge
HTML page) which Authentication data, the method of
requires that the (outside scope of authentication to be used
organisation is IOTP) and optionally a request
authenticated for Organisation
information then sends it
to the first organisation
|
v
3. The first organisation Component:
optionally checks any signature <------------ Authentication Data
associated with the Authentication
Authentication request then Request
uses the challenge data with
the specified authentication
method to generate an
Authentication Response which
is sent back to the second
organisation together with
details of any Organisation
information requested
|
v
Component: 4. The Authentication Response is
Authentication -------------> checked against the challenge data to
Response Authentication check that the first organisation is
Response who they appear to be and the result
recorded in a Status Component which
is then sent back to the first
organisation
|
v
5. The first organisation then Component: Status
optionally checks the results <------------
of the Status and any Authentication
associated signature and takes Status
the appropriate action or
stops.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
David Burdett et al. [Page 32]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Figure 5 Authentication Exchange
An Authentication Exchange uses the following Trading Components that
are passed between the two organisations:
o the Authentication Data Component which contains the challenge
data to be used in the "challenge-response" mechanism,
indicates the authentication method to be used and optionally
request Organisation data about the first organisation, for
example a ship to or billing address. It is sent by one
organisation to the other.
o The Authentication Response Component which contains the
challenge response generated by the recipient of the
Authentication Data Component. It is sent back to the first
organisation for verification together with Organisation
Components requested
o the Status Component which contains the results of the second
party's verification of the Authentication Response.
2.3 Scope of Baseline IOTP
This specification describes the IOTP Transactions which make up
Baseline IOTP. As described in the preface, IOTP will evolve over
time. This section defines the initial conformance criteria for
implementations that claim to _support IOTP._
The main determinant on the scope of an IOTP implementation is the
roles which the solution is designed to support. The roles within IOTP
are described in more detail in section 2.1 Trading Roles. To
summarise the roles are: Merchant, Consumer, Payment Handler, Delivery
Handler and Customer Care Provider.
Payment Handlers who can be of three types:
o those who accept a payment as part of a purchase or make a
payment as part of a refund,
o those who accept value as part of a deposit transaction, or
o those that issue value a withdrawal transaction
David Burdett et al. [Page 33]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The following table defines, for each role, the IOTP Transactions and
Trading Blocks which must be supported for that role.
Merchants
ECash ECash
Store Value Value Consumer Payment Delivery
Issuer Acquirer Handler Handler
TRANSACTIONS
Purchase Must Must
Refund Must b)
Depends
Authentication May Must May b)
Depends
Value Exchange May Must
Withdrawal Must b)
Depends
Deposit Must b)
Depends
Inquiry Must Must Must Must Must Must
Ping Must Must Must Must Must Must
David Burdett et al. [Page 34]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Merchants
ECash ECash
Store Value Value Consumer Payment Delivery
Issuer Acquirer Handler Handler
TRADING BLOCKS
TPO Must Must Must Must
TPO Selection Must Must Must Must
Auth-Request a) a) a)
Depends Depends Depends
Auth-Reply a) a) a)
Depends Depends Depends
Offer Response Must Must Must Must
Payment Must Must
Request
Payment Must Must
Exchange
Payment Must Must
Response
Delivery Must Must
Request
David Burdett et al. [Page 35]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Merchants
ECash ECash
Store Value Value Consumer Payment Delivery
Issuer Acquirer Handler Handler
Delivery Must Must
Response
Inquiry Must Must Must Must Must Must
Request
Inquiry Must Must Must Must Must Must
Response
Ping Request Must Must Must Must Must Must
Ping Response Must Must Must Must Must Must
Signature Must Must Must Limited Must Must
Error Must Must Must Must Must Must
In the above table:
o _Must_ means that a Trading Role must support the Transaction
or Trading Block.
o _May_ means that an implementation may support the Transaction
or Trading Block at the option of the developer.
o _Depends_ means implementation of the Transaction or Trading
Block depends on one of the following conditions:
a) if Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction is supported;
David Burdett et al. [Page 36]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
b) if required by a Payment Method as defined in its IOTP
Supplement document.
o "Limited" means the Trading Block must be understood and its
content manipulated but not in every respect. Specifically, on
the Signature Block, Consumers do not have to be able to
validate digital signatures.
An IOTP solution must support all the IOTP Transactions and Trading
Blocks required by at least one role (column) as described in the
above table for that solution to be described as "supporting IOTP".
David Burdett et al. [Page 37]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3. Protocol Structure
The previous section provided an introduction which explained:
o Trading Roles which are the different roles which organisations
can take in a trade: Consumer, Merchant, Payment Handler,
Delivery Handler and Customer Care Provider, and
o Trading Exchanges where each Trading Exchange involves the
exchange of data, between Trading Roles, in the form of a set
of Trading Components.
This section describes:
o how Trading Components are constructed into Trading Blocks and
the IOTP Messages which are physically sent in the form of
[XML] documents between the different Trading Roles,
o how IOTP Messages are exchanged between Trading Roles to create
an IOTP Transaction
o the XML definitions of an IOTP Message including a Transaction
Reference Block - an XML element which identifies an IOTP
Transaction and the IOTP Message within it
o the definitions of the XML ID Attributes which are used to
identify IOTP Messages, Trading Blocks and Trading Components
and how these are referred to using Element References from
other XML elements
o an overview of Brands and Brand Selection which describes how a
Consumer can select a Brand from a list provided by the
Merchant
o how extra XML Elements and new user defined values for existing
IOTP codes can be used when Extending IOTP,
o how IOTP uses the Packaged Content Element to embed data such
as payment protocol messages or detailed order definitions
within an IOTP Message
o how IOTP Identifies Languages so that different languages can
be used within IOTP Messages
David Burdett et al. [Page 38]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o how IOTP handles both Secure and Insecure Net Locations when
sending messages
o how an IOTP Transaction can be cancelled.
David Burdett et al. [Page 39]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.1 Overview
3.1.1 IOTP Message Structure
The structure of an IOTP Message and its relationship with Trading
Blocks and Trading Components is illustrated in the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
IOTP MESSAGE <---------- IOTP Message - an XML Document which is
| transported between the Trading Roles
|-Trans Ref Block <----- Trans Ref Block - contains information which
| | describes the IOTP Transaction and the IOTP
| | Message.
| |-Trans Id Comp. <--- Transaction Id Component - uniquely
| | identifies the IOTP Transaction. The Trans Id
| | Components are the same across all IOTP
| | messages that comprise a single IOTP
| | transaction.
| |-Msg Id Comp. <----- Message Id Component - identifies and
| describes an IOTP Message within an IOTP
| Transaction
|-Signature Block <----- Signature Block (optional) - contains one or
| | more Signature Components and their
| | associated Certificates
| |-Signature Comp. <-- Signature Component - contains digital
| | signatures. Signatures may sign digests of
| | the Trans Ref Block and any Trading Component
| | in any IOTP Message in the same IOTP
| | transaction.
| |-Certificate Comp. < Certificate Component. Used to check the
| signature.
|-Trading Block <------- Trading Block - an XML Element within an IOTP
| |-Component Message that contains a predefined set of
| |-Component Trading Components
| |-Component
| |-Component <-------- Trading Components - XML Elements within a
| Trading Block that contain a predefined set
|-Trading Block of XML elements and attributes containing
| |-Component information required to support a Trading
| |-Component Exchange
| |-Component
| |-Component
| |-Component
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
David Burdett et al. [Page 40]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Figure 6 IOTP Message Structure
The diagram also introduces the concept of a Transaction Reference
Block. This block contains, amongst other things, a globally unique
identifier for the IOTP Transaction. Also each block and component is
given an ID Attribute (see section 3.4) which is unique within an IOTP
Transaction. Therefore the combination of the ID attribute and the
globally unique identifier in the Transaction Reference Block is
sufficient to uniquely identify any Trading Block or Trading
Component.
David Burdett et al. [Page 41]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.1.2 IOTP Transactions
A predefined set of IOTP Messages exchanged between the Trading Roles
constitute an IOTP Transaction. This is illustrated in the diagram
below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER MERCHANT
Generate first
IOTP Message
--- |
| | v
Process incoming | I | -------------
IOTP Message & <------------- | | -------------- | IOTP Message |
generate next IOTP | | -------------
Message | N |
| | |
v | |
------------- | T | Process incoming
| IOTP Message | -------------- | | -------------> IOTP Message &
------------- | | generate next
| E | IOTP Message
| | |
| | v
Process incoming | R | -------------
IOTP Message <------------- | | -------------- | IOTP Message |
generate last IOTP | | -------------
Message & stop | N |
| | |
v | |
------------- | E | Process last
| IOTP Message | -------------- | | -------------> incoming IOTP
------------- | | Message & stop
| | T | |
v | | v
STOP --- STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 7 An IOTP Transaction
In the above diagram the Internet is shown as the transport mechanism.
This is not necessarily the case. IOTP Messages can be transported
using a variety of transport mechanisms.
David Burdett et al. [Page 42]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The IOTP Transactions (see section 8) in this version of IOTP are
specifically:
o Purchase. This supports a purchase involving an offer, a
payment and optionally a delivery
o Refund. This supports the refund of a payment as a result of,
typically, an earlier purchase
o Value Exchange. This involves two payments which result in the
exchange of value from one combination of currency and payment
method to another
o Authentication. This supports the remote authentication of a
Consumer by another Trading Role using a variety of
authentication methods, and the provision of an Organisation
Component about a Consumer to another Trading Role for use in,
for example the creation of an offer
o Withdrawal. This supports the withdrawal of electronic cash
from a financial institution
o Deposit. This supports the deposit of electronic cash at a
financial institution
o Inquiry This supports inquiries on the status of an IOTP
transaction which is either in progress or is complete
o Ping This supports a simple query which enables one IOTP aware
application to determine whether another IOTP application
running elsewhere is working or not.
3.2 IOTP Message
As described earlier, IOTP Messages are [XML] documents which are
physically sent between the different Trading Roles that are taking
part in a trade.
The XML definition of an IOTP Message is as follows.
David Burdett et al. [Page 43]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT OtpMessage
( TransRefBlk,
SigBlk?,
ErrorBlk?,
( AuthReqBlk |
AuthRespBlk |
AuthStatusBlk |
CancelBlk |
DeliveryReqBlk |
DeliveryRespBlk |
InquiryReqBlk |
InquiryRespBlk |
OfferRespBlk |
PayExchBlk |
PayReqBlk |
PayRespBlk |
PingReqBlk |
PingRespBlk |
TpoBlk |
TpoSelectionBlk
)*
) >
<!ATTLIST OtpMessage
xmlns:iotp CDATA
'ietf.org/draft-ietf-trade-iotp-v1.0-protocol-03' >
Content:
TransRefBlk This contains information which describes an
IOTP Message within an IOTP Transaction (see
section 3.3 immediately below)
AuthReqBlk, These are the Trading Blocks.
AuthRespBlk,
DeliveryReqBlk, The Trading Blocks present within an IOTP
DeliveryRespBlk Message, and the content of a Trading Block
ErrorBlk itself is dependent on the type of IOTP
InquiryReqBlk, Transaction being carried out - see the
InquiryRespBlk, definition of each transaction in section 8
OfferRespBlk, Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions.
PayExchBlk,
PayReqBlk, Full definitions of each Trading Block are
PayRespBlk, described in section 7.
PingReqBlk,
PingRespBlk,
SigBlk,
David Burdett et al. [Page 44]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
TpoBlk,
TpoSelectionBlk
Attributes
xmlns:iotp The [XML Namespace] definition for IOTP
messages.
3.2.1 XML Document Prolog
The IOTP Message is the root element of the XML document. It therefore
needs to be preceded by an appropriate XML Document Prolog. For
example:
<?XML Version='1.0'?>
<!DOCTYPE OtpMessage >
<OtpMessage>
...
</OtpMessage>
3.3 Transaction Reference Block
A Transaction Reference Block contains information which identifies
the IOTP Transaction and IOTP Message. The Transaction Reference Block
contains:
o a Transaction Id Component which globally uniquely identifies
the IOTP Transaction. The Transaction Id Components are the
same across all IOTP messages that comprise a single IOTP
transaction,
o a Message Id Component which provides control information about
the IOTP Message as well as uniquely identifying the IOTP
Message within an IOTP Transaction, and
o zero or more Related To Components which link this IOTP
Transaction to either other IOTP Transactions or other events
using the identifiers of those events.
The definition of a Transaction Reference Block is as follows:
David Burdett et al. [Page 45]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT TransRefBlk (TransId, MsgId, RelatedTo*) >
<!ATTLIST TransRefBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Transaction Reference Block within the IOTP
Transaction (see section 3.4 ID Attributes).
Content:
TransId See 3.3.1 Transaction Id Component immediately
below.
MsgId See 3.3.2 Message Id Component immediately
below.
RelatedTo See 3.3.3 Related To Component immediately
below.
3.3.1 Transaction Id Component
This contains information which globally uniquely identifies the IOTP
Transaction. Its definition is as follows:
<!ELEMENT TransId EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST TransId
ID ID #REQUIRED
Version NMTOKEN #FIXED '1.0'
OtpTransId NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OtpTransType CDATA #REQUIRED
TransTimeStamp CDATA #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Transaction Id Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
Version This identifies the version of IOTP, and
therefore the structure of the IOTP Messages,
which the IOTP Transaction is using.
OtpTransId Contains data which uniquely identifies the IOTP
David Burdett et al. [Page 46]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Transaction. It must conform to the rules for
Message Ids in [RFC 822].
OtpTransType This is the type of IOTP Transaction being
carried out. For Baseline IOTP it identifies a
"standard" IOTP Transaction and implies the
sequence and content of the IOTP Messages
exchanged between the Trading Roles. The valid
values for Baseline IOTP are:
o BaselineAuthentication
o BaselineDeposit
o BaselinePurchase
o BaselineRefund
o BaselineWithdrawal
o BaselineValueExchange
o BaselineInquiry
o BaselinePing
Values of OtpTransType are managed under the
procedure described in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes which also allows user defined values
of OtpTransType to be defined.
In later versions of IOTP, this list will be
extended to support different types of standard
IOTP Transaction based on market demand. It is
also likely to support the type Dynamic which
indicates that the sequence of steps within the
transaction are non-standard.
TransTimeStamp Where the system initiating the IOTP Transaction
has an internal clock, it is set to the time at
which the IOTP Transaction started in [UTC]
format.
The main purpose of this attribute is to provide
an alternative way of identifying a transaction
by specifying the time at which it started.
Some systems, for example, hand held devices may
not be able to generate a time stamp. In this
case this attribute should contain the value
"NA" for Not Available.
David Burdett et al. [Page 47]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.3.2 Message Id Component
The Message Id Component provides control information about the IOTP
Message as well as uniquely identifying the IOTP Message within an
IOTP Transaction. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT MsgId EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST MsgId
ID ID #REQUIRED
RespOtpMsg NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
SenderTradingRoleRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
SoftwareId CDATA #REQUIRED
TimeStamp CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the IOTP
Message within the IOTP Transaction (see section
3.4 ID Attributes). Note that if an IOTP Message
is resent then the value of this attribute
remains the same.
RespOtpMsg This contains the ID attribute of the Message Id
Component of the IOTP Message to which this IOTP
Message is a response. In this way all the IOTP
Messages in an IOTP Transaction are
unambiguously linked together. This field is
required on every IOTP Message except the first
IOTP Message in an IOTP Transaction.
SenderTradingRoleR The Element Reference (see section 3.5) of the
ef Trading Role which has generated the IOTP
message. It is used to identify the Net
Locations (see section 3.10) of the Trading Role
to which problems Technical Errors (see section
4.1) with any of Trading Blocks should be
reported.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
SoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the IOTP Message. Its
purpose is to help resolve interoperability
David Burdett et al. [Page 48]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
problems that might occur as a result of
incompatibilities between messages produced by
different software. It is a single text string
in the language defined by xml:lang. It must
contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
TimeStamp Where the device sending the message has an
internal clock, it is set to the time at which
the IOTP Message was created in [UTC] format.
3.3.3 Related To Component
The Related To Component links IOTP Transactions to either other IOTP
Transactions or other events using the identifiers of those events.
Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT RelatedTo (PackagedContent) >
<!ATTLIST RelatedTo
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
RelationshipType NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
Relation CDATA #REQUIRED
RelnKeyWords NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Related To Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
RelationshipType Defines the type of the relationship. Valid
values are:
o OtpTransaction. in which case the Packaged
Content Element contains an OtpTransId of
another IOTP Transaction
o Reference in which case the Packaged Content
Element contains the reference of some other,
David Burdett et al. [Page 49]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
non-IOTP document.
Values of RelationshipType are controlled under
the procedures defined in section 3.7.3 Values
for IOTP Codes which also allows user defined
values to be defined.
Relation The Relation attribute contains a phrase in the
language defined by xml:lang which describes the
nature of the relationship between the IOTP
transaction that contains this component and
another IOTP Transaction or other event. The
exact words to be used are left to the
implementers of the IOTP software.
The purpose of the attribute is to provide the
Trading Roles involved in an IOTP Transaction
with an explanation of the nature of the
relationship between the transactions.
Care should be taken that the words used to in
the Relation attribute indicate the "direction"
of the relationship correctly. For example: one
transaction might be a refund for another
earlier transaction. In this case the
transaction which is a refund should contain in
the Relation attribute words such as "refund
for" rather than "refund to" or just "refund".
RelnKeyWords This attribute contains keywords which could be
used to help identify similar relationships, for
example all refunds. It is anticipated that
recommended keywords will be developed through
examination of actual usage. In this version of
the specification there are no specific
recommendations and the keywords used are at the
discretion of implementers.
Content:
PackagedContent The Packaged Content (see section 3.8) contains
data which identifies the related transaction.
Its format varies depending on the value of the
RelationshipType.
David Burdett et al. [Page 50]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.4 ID Attributes
IOTP Messages, Blocks (i.e. Transaction Reference Blocks and Trading
Blocks), Trading Components (including the Transaction Id Component
and the Signature Component) and some of their child elements are each
given an XML "ID" attribute which is used to identify an instance of
these XML elements. These identifiers are used so that one element can
be referenced by another. All these attributes are given the attribute
name ID.
The values of each ID attribute are unique within an IOTP transaction
i.e. the set of IOTP Messages which have the same globally unique
Transaction ID Component. Also, once the ID attribute of an element
has been assigned a value it is never changed. This means that
whenever an element is copied, the value of the ID attribute remains
the same.
As a result it is possible to use these IDs to refer to and locate the
content of any IOTP Message, Block or Component from any other IOTP
Message, Block or Component in the same IOTP Transaction using Element
References (see section 3.5).
This section defines the rules for setting the values for the ID
attributes of IOTP Messages, Blocks and Components.
David Burdett et al. [Page 51]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.4.1 IOTP Message ID Attribute Definition
The ID attribute of the Message Id Component of an IOTP Message must
be unique within an IOTP Transaction. It's definition is as follows:
OtpMsgId_value ::= OtpMsgIdPrefix OtpMsgIdSuffix
OtpMsgIdPrefix ::= NameChar (NameChar)*
OtpMsgIdSuffix ::= Digit (Digit)*
OtpMsgIdPrefix Apart from messages which contain an Inquiry
Request Trading Block (see section 7.12), the
same prefix is used for all messages sent by the
Merchant or Consumer role as follows:
o "M" - Merchant
o "C" - Consumer
For messages which contain an Inquiry Request
Trading Block, the prefix is set to "I" for
Inquiry.
The prefix for the other roles in a trade is
contained within the Organisation Component for
the role and are typically set by the Merchant.
The following is recommended as a guideline and
must not be relied upon:
o "P" - First (only) Payment Handler
o "R" - Second Payment Handler
o "D" - Delivery Handler
As a guideline, prefixes should be limited to
one character.
NameChar has the same definition as the [XML]
definition of NameChar.
OtpMsgIdSuffix The suffix consists of one or more digits. The
suffix must be unique within a Trading Role
within an IOTP Transaction. The following is
recommended as a guideline and must not be
relied upon:
o the first IOTP Message sent by a trading role
is given the suffix "1"
o the second and subsequent IOTP Messages sent
by the same trading role are incremented by
one for each message
o no leading zeroes are included in the suffix
David Burdett et al. [Page 52]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Put more simply the Message Id Component of the
first IOTP Message sent by a Consumer would have
an ID attribute of, "C1", the second "C2", the
third "C3" etc.
Digit has the same definition as the [XML]
definition of Digit.
3.4.2 Block and Component ID Attribute Definitions
The ID Attribute of Blocks and Components must also be unique within
an IOTP Transaction. Their definition is as follows:
BlkOrCompId_value ::= OtpMsgId_value "." IdSuffix
IdSuffix ::= Digit (Digit)*
OtpMsgId_value The ID attribute of the Message ID Component of
the IOTP Message where the Block or Component is
first used.
In IOTP, Trading Components and Trading Blocks
are copied from one IOTP Message to another. The
ID attribute does not change when an existing
Trading Block or Component is copied to another
IOTP Message.
IdSuffix The suffix consists of one or more digits. The
suffix must be unique within the ID attribute of
the Message ID Component used to generate the ID
attribute. The following is recommended as a
guideline and must not be relied upon:
o the first Block or Component sent by a trading
role is given the suffix "1"
o the ID attributes of the second and subsequent
Blocks or Components are incremented by one
for each new Block or Component added to an
IOTP Message
o no leading zeroes are included in the suffix
Put more simply, the first new Block or
Component added to the second IOTP Message sent,
for example, by a consumer would have a an ID
attribute of "C2.1", the second "C2.2", the
third "C2.3" etc.
David Burdett et al. [Page 53]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Digit has the same definition as the [XML]
definition of Digit.
3.4.3 Example of use of ID Attributes
The diagram below illustrates how ID attribute values are used.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
1st IOTP MESSAGE 2nd IOTP MESSAGE
(e.g. from Merchant to (e.g. from Consumer to
Consumer Payment Handler)
IOTP MESSAGE IOTP MESSAGE *
|-Trans Ref Block. ID=M1.1 |-Trans Ref Block.ID=C1.1*
| |-Trans Id Comp. ID = M1. ------------->| |-Trans Id Comp.
| | Copy Element | | ID=M1.2
| |-Msg Id Comp. ID = M1 | |-Msg Id Comp. ID=C1 *
| |
|-Signature Block. ID=M1.8 |-Signature Block.ID=C1.5*
| |-Sig Comp. ID=M1.15 ---- ------------->| |-Comp. ID=M1.15
| Copy Element |
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.3 |-Trading Block. ID=C1.2 *
| |-Comp. ID=M1.4 --------- ---------------->|-Comp. ID=M1.4
| | Copy Element |
| |-Comp. ID=M1.5 --------- ---------------->|-Comp. ID=M1.5
| | Copy Element |
| |-Comp. ID=M1.6 |-Comp. ID=C1.3 *
| |-Comp. ID=M1.7 |-Comp. ID=C1.4 *
|
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.3
|-Comp. ID=M1.4 * = new elements
|-Comp. ID=M1.5
|-Comp. ID=M1.6
|-Comp. ID=M1.7
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 8 Example use of ID attributes
David Burdett et al. [Page 54]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.5 Element References
A Trading Component or one of its child XML elements, may contain an
XML attribute that refers to another Block (i.e. a Transaction
Reference Block or a Trading Block) or Trading Component (including a
Transaction Id and Signature Component). These Element References are
used for many purposes, a few examples include:
o identifying an XML element whose Digest is included in a
Signature Component,
o referring to the Payment Handler Organisation Component which
is used when making a Payment
An Element Reference always contains the value of an ID attribute of a
Block or Component.
Identifying the IOTP Message, Trading Block or Trading Component which
is referred to by an Element Reference, involves finding the XML
element which:
o belongs to the same IOTP Transaction (i.e. the Transaction Id
Components of the IOTP Messages match), and
o where the value of the ID attribute of the element matches the
value of the Element Reference.
[Note] The term "match" in this specification has the same
definition as the [XML] definition of match.
[Note End]
An example of "matching" an Element Reference is illustrated in the
example below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 55]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
1st IOTP MESSAGE 2nd IOTP MESSAGE
(e.g. from Merchant to (e.g. from Consumer to
Consumer Payment Handler)
IOTP MESSAGE IOTP MESSAGE
|-Trans Ref Block. ID=M1.1 Trans ID |-Trans Ref Block. ID=C1.1
| |-Trans Id Comp. ID = M1. <-Components--|->|-Trans Id Comp.ID=M1.2
| | must be | |
| |-Msg Id Comp. ID = M1 Identical | |-Msg Id Comp. ID=C1
| ^ |
|-Signature Block. ID=M1.8 | |-Signature Block. ID=C1.5
| |-Sig Comp. ID=M1.15 | | |-Comp. ID=M1.15
| AND |
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.3 | |-Trading Block. ID=C1.2
| |-Comp. ID=M1.4 | |-Comp. ID=M1.4
| | v |
| |-Comp. ID=M1.5 <-------- -ID Attribute |-Comp. ID=M1.5
| | and El Ref |
| |-Comp. ID=M1.6 values must |-Comp. ID=C1.3
| | match--------|--> El Ref=M1.6
| |-Comp. ID=M1.7 |-Comp. ID=C1.4
|
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.3
|-Comp. ID=M1.4
|-Comp. ID=M1.5
|-Comp. ID=M1.6
|-Comp. ID=M1.7
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 9 Element References
[Note] Element Reference attributes are defined as "NMTOKEN" rather
than "IDREF" (see [XML]). This is because an IDREF requires
that the XML element referred to is in the same XML
Document. With IOTP this is not necessarily the case.
[Note End]
3.6 Brands and Brand Selection
One of the key features of IOTP is the ability for a merchant to offer
a list of Brands from which a consumer may make a selection. This
David Burdett et al. [Page 56]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
section provides an overview of what is involved and provides guidance
on how selection of a brand and associated payment instrument can be
carried out by a Consumer. It covers:
o definitions of Payment Instruments and Brands - what are
Payment Instruments and Brands in an IOTP context. Further
categorises Brands as optionally a "Dual Brand" or a
"Promotional Brand",
o identification and selection of Promotional Brands -
Promotional Brands offer a Consumer some additional benefit,
for example loyalty points or a discount. This means that both
Consumers and Merchant must be able to correctly identify that
a valid Promotional Brand is being used.
Also see the following sections:
o Brand List Component (section 6.6) which contains definitions
of the XML elements which contain the list of Brands offered by
a Merchant to a Consumer, and
o Brand Selection Component (section 6.7) for details of how a
Consumer records the Brand that was selected.
3.6.1 Definition of Payment Instrument
A Payment Instrument is the means by which a Consumer pays for goods
or services offered by a Merchant. It can be, for example:
o a credit card such as MasterCard or Visa;
o a debit card such as MasterCard's Maestro;
o a smart card based electronic cash payment instrument such as a
Mondex Card, a GeldKarte card or a Visa Cash card
o a software based electronic payment account such as a CyberCash
or DigiCash account.
All Payment Instruments have a number, typically an account number, by
which the Payment Instrument can be identified.
David Burdett et al. [Page 57]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.6.2 Definition of Brand
A Brand is the mark which identifies a particular type of Payment
Instrument. A list of Brands are the payment options which are
presented by the Merchant to the Consumer and from which the Consumer
makes a selection. Each Brand may have a different Payment Handler.
Examples of Brands include:
o payment association and proprietary Brands, for example
MasterCard, Visa, American Express, Diners Club, Mondex,
GeldKarte, CyberCash, etc.
o promotional brands (see below). These include:
- store brands, where the Payment Instrument is issued to a Consumer
by a particular Merchant, for example Walmart, Sears, or Marks and
Spencer (UK)
- cobrands, for example American Advantage Visa, where an
organisation uses their own brand in conjunction with, typically,
a payment association Brand.
3.6.3 Definition of Dual Brand
A Dual Brand means that a single payment instrument may be used as if
it were two separate Brands. For example there could be a single
Japanese "UC" MasterCard which can be used as either a UC card or a
regular MasterCard. The UC card Brand and the MasterCard Brand could
each have their own separate Payment Handlers. This means that:
o the merchant treats, for example "UC" and "MasterCard" as two
separate Brands when offering a list of Brands to the Consumer,
o the consumer chooses a Brand, for example either "UC" or
"MasterCard,
o the consumer IOTP aware application determines which Payment
Instrument(s) match the chosen Brand, and selects, perhaps with
user assistance, the correct Payment Instrument to use.
[Note] Dual Brands need no special treatment by the Merchant and
therefore no explicit reference is made to Dual Brands in
the DTD. This is because, as far as the Merchant is
concerned, each Brand in a Dual Brand is treated as a
separate Brand. It is at the Consumer, that the matching of
a Brand to a Dual Brand Payment Instrument needs to be done.
[Note End]
David Burdett et al. [Page 58]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.6.4 Definition of Promotional Brand
A Promotional Brand means that, if the Consumer pays with that Brand,
then the Consumer will receive some additional benefit which can be
received in two ways:
o at the time of purchase. For example if a Consumer pays with a
"Walmart MasterCard" at a Walmart web site, then a 5% discount
might apply, which means the consumer actually pays less,
o from their Payment Instrument (card) issuer when the payment
appears on their statement. For example loyalty points in a
frequent flyer scheme could be awarded based on the total
payments made with the Payment Instrument since the last
statement was issued.
Note that:
o the first example (obtaining the benefit at the time of
purchase), requires that:
- the Consumer is informed of the benefits which arise if that Brand
is selected
- if the Brand is selected, the Merchant changes the relevant IOTP
Components in the Offer Response to reflect the correct amount to
be paid
o the second (obtaining a benefit through the Payment Instrument
issuer) does not require that the Offer Response is changed
o each Promotional Brand should be identified as a separate Brand
in the list of Brands offered by the Merchant. For example:
"Walmart", "Sears", "Marks and Spencer" and "American Advantage
Visa", would each be a separate Brand.
3.6.5 Identifying Promotional Brands
There are two problems which need to handled in identifying
Promotional Brands:
o how does the Merchant or their Payment Handler positively
identify the promotional brand being used at the time of
purchase
o how does the Consumer reliably identify the correct promotional
brand from the Brand List presented by the Merchant
David Burdett et al. [Page 59]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The following is a description of how this could be achieved.
[Note] Please note that the approach described here is a model
approach that solves the problem. Other equivalent methods
may be used.
[Note End]
3.6.5.1 Merchant/Payment Handler Identification of Promotional Brands
Correct identification that the Consumer is paying using a Promotional
Brand is important since a Consumer might fraudulently claim to have a
Promotional Brand that offers a reduced payment amount when in reality
they do not.
Two approaches seem possible:
o use some feature of the Payment Instrument or the payment
method to positively identify the Brand being used. For
example, the SET certificate for the Brand could be used, if
one is available, or
o use the Payment Instrument (card) number to look up information
about the Payment Instrument on a Payment Instrument issuer
database to determine if the Payment Instrument is a
promotional brand
Note that:
o the first assumes that SET is available.
o the second is only possible if the Merchant, or alternatively
the Payment Handler, has access to card issuer information.
IOTP does not provide the Merchant with Payment Instrument information
(e.g. a card or account number). This is only sent as part of the
encapsulated payment protocol to a Payment Handler. This means that:
o the Merchant would have to assume that the Payment Instrument
selected was a valid Promotional Brand, or
o the Payment Handler would have to check that the Payment
Instrument was for the valid Promotional Brand and fail the
payment if it was not.
A Payment Handler checking that a brand is a valid Promotional Brand
is most likely if the Payment Handler is also the Card Issuer.
David Burdett et al. [Page 60]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.6.5.2 Consumer Selection of Promotional Brands
Two ways by which a Consumer can correctly select a Promotional Brand
are:
o the Consumer visually matching a logo for the Promotional Brand
which has been provided to the Consumer by the Merchant,
o the Consumer's IOTP aware application matching a code for the
Promotional Brand which the application has registered against
a similar code contained in the list of Brands offered by the
Merchant.
In the latter case, the code contained in the Consumer wallet must
match exactly the code in the list offered by the Merchant otherwise
no match will be found. Ways in which the Consumer's IOTP Aware
Application could obtain such a code include:
o the Consumer types the code in directly. This is error prone
and not user friendly, also the consumer needs to be provided
with the code. This approach is not recommended,
o using some information contained in the software or other data
associated with the Payment Instrument. This could be:
- a SET certificate for Brands which use this payment method
- a code provided by the payment software which handles the
particular payment method, this could apply to, for example,
GeldKarte, Mondex, CyberCash and DigiCash
o the consumer making a initial "manual" link between a
Promotional Brand in the list of Brands offered by the Merchant
and an individual Payment Instrument, the first time the
promotional brand is used. The IOTP Aware application would
then "remember" the code for the Promotional Brand for use in
future purchases
[Note] It is not the intention of the developers of this
specification to develop a prescriptive list of payment
brands. It is anticipated that owners of brands will develop
distinctive names for Brands which should mean that name
clashes are unlikely.
[Note End]
David Burdett et al. [Page 61]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
3.7 Extending IOTP
Baseline IOTP defines a minimum protocol which systems supporting IOTP
must be able to accept. As new versions of IOTP are developed,
additional types of IOTP Transactions will be defined. In addition to
this, Baseline and future versions of IOTP will support user
extensions to IOTP through two mechanisms:
o extra XML elements, and
o new values for existing IOTP codes.
3.7.1 Extra XML Elements
The XML element and attribute names used within IOTP constitute an
[XML Namespace] as identified by the xmlns attribute on the OtpMessage
element. This allows IOTP to support the inclusion of additional XML
elements within IOTP messages through the use of [XML Namespaces].
Using XML Namespaces, extra XML elements may be included at any level
within an IOTP message including:
o new Trading Blocks
o new Trading Components
o new XML elements within a Trading Component.
The following rules apply:
o any new XML element must be declared according to the rules for
[XML Namespaces]
o new XML elements which are either Trading Blocks or Trading
Components must contain an ID attributes with an attribute name
of ID.
In order to make sure that extra XML elements can be processed
properly, IOTP reserves the use of a special attribute, IOTP:Critical,
which takes the values True or False and may appear in extra elements
added to an IOTP message.
The purpose of this attribute is to allow an IOTP aware application to
determine if the IOTP transaction can safely continue. Specifically:
David Burdett et al. [Page 62]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o if an extra XML element has an "IOTP:Critical" attribute with a
value of "True" and an IOTP aware application does not know how
to process the element and its child elements, then the IOTP
transaction has a Technical Error (see section 4.1) and must
fail.
o if an extra XML element has an "IOTP:Critical" attribute with a
value of "False" then the IOTP transaction may continue if the
IOTP aware application does not know how to process it. In this
case:
- any extra XML elements contained within an XML element defined
within the IOTP namespace, must be included with that element
whenever the IOTP XML element is used or copied by IOTP
- the content of the extra element must be ignored except that it
must be included when it is used in the creation of a digest as
part of the generation of a signature
o if an extra XML element has no "IOTP:Critical" attribute then
it must be treated as if it had an "IOTP:Critical" attribute
with a value of "True"
o if an XML element contains an "IOTP:Critical" attribute, then
the value of that attribute is assumed to apply to all the
child elements within that element
In order to ensure that documents containing "IOTP:Critical" are
valid, it is declared as part of the DTD for the extra element as:
IOTP:Critical (True | False ) #TRUE
3.7.2 Opaque Embedded Data
If IOTP is to be extended using Opaque Embedded Data then a Packaged
Content Element (see section 3.8) should be used to encapsulate the
data.
3.7.3 Values for IOTP Codes
Codes used by IOTP are registered by [IANA] so that new values can be
co-ordinated based on an IETF consensus as defined in RFC 2434.
The element types, attributes names to which this procedure applies is
shown in the table below together with the original values for
attributes which apply. For more up-to-date information on valid
David Burdett et al. [Page 63]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
values and how these relate to versions of the IOTP specification
contact IANA.
Element Type Attribute Attribute Values
Name
AuthData AuthMethod sha1
signature
pay:ppp where ppp may be set to any
valid value for iotpbrand (see below)
Brand BrandId SET:setbrand where setbrand is a brand
which is accepted by the [SET] payment
protocol
IOTP:iotpbrand where iotpbrand may be:
o GeldKarte
o Mondex
CurrencyAmount CurrCode TBD. Codes which apply when the
CurrCodeType attribute is set to IOTP
are to be defined
CurrencyAmount CurrCodeType ISO4217
IOTP
DeliveryData DelivMethod Post
Web
Email
PackagedContent Content PCDATA
MIME
MIME:mimetype (where mimetype must be
the same as content-type as defined by
[MIME] )
XML
PayProtocol ProtocolId The values of ProtocolId are to be
defined by the payment scheme/method
David Burdett et al. [Page 64]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
owners.
RelatedTo Relationship OtpTransaction
Type
Reference
Status StatusType Offer
Payment
Delivery
Authentication
TradingRole TradingRole Consumer
Merchant
PaymentHandler
DeliveryHandler
DelivTo
CustCare
TransId OtpTransType BaselineAuthentication
BaselineDeposit
BaselinePurchase
BaselineRefund
BaselineWithdrawal
BaselineValueExchange
BaselineInquiry
BaselinePing
Attibute Content OfferResponse
(within
Signature PaymentResponse
Component)
DeliveryResponse
David Burdett et al. [Page 65]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
AuthenticationRequest
AuthenticationResponse
PingRequest
PingResponse
However there is still a need for developers to experiment using new
IOTP codes. For this reason, "user defined codes" may be used to
identify additional values for the codes contained within this
specification with the need for them to be registered with IANA.
The definition of a user defined code is as follows:
user_defined_code ::= ( "x-" | "X-" ) NameChar (NameChar)*
NameChar NameChar has the same definition as the [XML]
definition of NameChar
Use of domain names (see [DNS]) to make user defined codes unique is
recommended although this method cannot be relied upon.
3.8 Packaged Content Element
The Packaged Content element supports the concept of an embedded data
stream, transformed to both protect it against misinterpretation by
transporting systems and to ensure XML compatibility. Examples of its
use in IOTP include:
o to encapsulate payment scheme messages, such as SET messages,
o to encapsulate a description of an order, a payment note, or a
delivery note.
In general it is used to encapsulate one or more data streams.
This data stream has three standardised attributes that allow for
identification, decoding and interpretation of the contents. Its
definition is as follows.
David Burdett et al. [Page 66]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT PackagedContent (#PCDATA) >
<!ATTLIST PackagedContent
Name NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Content NMTOKEN "PCDATA"
Transform (NONE|BASE64) "NONE" >
Attributes:
Name Optional. Distinguishes between multiple
occurrences of Packaged Content Elements at the
same point in IOTP. For example:
<ABCD>
<PackagedContent Name='FirstMsg'>
snroasdfnas934k
</PackagedContent>
<PackagedContent Name='SecondMsg'>
dvdsjnl5poidsdsflkjnw45
</PackagedContent>
</ABCD>
The name attribute may be omitted, for example
if there is only one Packaged Content element.
Content This identifies what type of data is contained
within the Content of the Packaged Content
Element. The valid values for the Content
attribute are as follows:
o PCDATA. The content of the Packaged Content
Element can be treated as PCDATA with no
further processing.
o MIME. The content of the Packaged Content
Element is a complete MIME item. Processing
should include looking for MIME headers inside
the Packaged Content Element.
o MIME:mimetype. The content of the Packaged
Content Element is MIME content, with the
following header "Content-Type: mimetype".
Although it is possible to have MIME:mimetype
with the Transform attribute set to NONE, it
is far more likely to have Transform attribute
set to BASE64. Note that if Transform is NONE
is used, then the entire content must still
conform to PCDATA. Some characters will need
to be encoded either as the XML default
entities, or as numeric character entities.
o XML. The content of the Packaged Content
David Burdett et al. [Page 67]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Element can be treated as an XML document.
Entities and CDATA sections, or Transform set
to BASE64, must be used to ensure that the
Packaged Content Element contents are
legitimate PCDATA.
Values of the Content attribute are controlled
under the procedures defined in section 3.7.3
Values for IOTP Codes which also allows user
defined values to be defined.
Transform This identifies the transformation that has been
done to the data before it was placed in the
content. Valid values are:
o NONE. The PCDATA content of the Packaged
Content Element is the correct representation
of the data. Note that entity expansion must
occur first (i.e. replacement of & and
) before the data is examined. CDATA
sections may legitimately occur in a Packaged
Content Element where the Transform attribute
is set to NONE.
o BASE64. The PCDATA content of the Packaged
Content Element represents a BASE64 encoding
of the actual content.
Content:
PCDATA This is the actual data which has been embedded.
The format of the data and rules on how to
decode it are contained in the Content and the
Transform attributes
Note that any special details, especially custom attributes, must be
represented at a higher level.
3.8.1 Packaging HTML
The packaged content may contain HTML. In this case the following
conventions are followed:
o references to any documents, images or other things, such as
sounds or web pages, which can affect the recipient's
understanding of the data which is being packaged must refer to
other Packaged Elements contained within the same parent
element, e.g. an Order Description
David Burdett et al. [Page 68]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o if more than one Packaged Content element is included within a
parent element in order to meet the previous requirement, then
the Name attribute of the top level Packaged Content from which
references to all other Packaged Elements can be determined,
should have a value of Main. This means that the "Main"
Packaged Content element must not be referred to from the HTML
in any other Packaged Content
o relative references to other documents, images, etc. from one
Packaged Content element to another are realised by setting the
value of the relative reference to the Name attribute of
another Packaged Content element at the same level and within
the same parent element
o no external references that require the reference to be
resolved immediately should be used. As this could make the
HTML difficult or impossible to display completely
o [MIME] is used to encapsulate the data inside each Packaged
Element. This means that the information in the MIME header
used to identify the type of data which has been encapsulated
and therefore how it should be displayed.
If the above conventions are not followed by, for example, including
external references which must be resolved, then the recipient of the
HTML should be informed.
[Note] As an implementation guideline the values of the Name
Attributes allocated to Packaged Content elements should
make it possible to extract each Packaged Content into a
directory and then display the HTML directly
[Note End]
3.9 Identifying Languages
IOTP uses [XML] Language Identification to specify which languages are
used within the content and attributes of IOTP Messages.
The following principles have been used in order to determine which
XML elements contain an xml:lang Attributes:
o a mandatory xml:lang attribute is contained on every Trading
Component which contains attributes or content which may need
to be displayed or printed in a particular language
David Burdett et al. [Page 69]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o an optional xml:lang attribute is included on child elements of
these Trading Components. In this case the value of xml:lang,
if present, overrides the value for the Trading Component.
xml:lang attributes which follow these principles are included in the
Trading Components and their child XML elements defined in section 6.
3.10 Secure and Insecure Net Locations
IOTP contains several "Net Locations" which identify places where,
typically, IOTP Messages may be sent. Net Locations come in two types:
o "Secure" Net Locations which are net locations where privacy of
data is secured using, for example, encryption methods such as
[SSL], and
o "Insecure" Net Locations where privacy of data is not assured.
Where both types of net location are present, the following rules
apply:
o either a Secure Net Location or an Insecure Net Location or
both must be present
o if only one of the two Net Locations is present, then the one
present must be used
o if both are present, then the either may be used depending on
the preference of the sender of the message.
3.11 Cancelled Transactions
Any Trading Role involved in an IOTP transaction may cancel that
transaction at any time.
3.11.1 Cancelling Transactions
IOTP Transactions are cancelled by sending an IOTP message containing
just a Cancel Block with an appropriate Status Component to the other
Trading Role involved in the Trading Exchange.
David Burdett et al. [Page 70]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[Note] The Cancel Block can be sent asynchronously of any other
IOTP Message. Specifically it can be sent either before
sending or after receiving an IOTP Message from the other
Trading Role
[Note End]
If an IOTP Transaction is cancelled during a Trading Exchange (i.e.
the interval between sending a _request_ block and receiving the
matching _response_ block) then the Cancel Block is sent to the same
location as the next IOTP Message in the Trading Exchange would have
been sent.
If a Consumer cancels a transaction after a Trading Exchange has
completed (i.e. the "response" block for the Trading Exchange has been
received), but before the IOTP Transaction has finished then the
Consumer sends a Cancel Block with an appropriate Status Component to
the net location identified by the SenderNetLocn or
SecureSenderNetLocn contained in the Protocol Options Component
contained in the TPO Block for the transaction. This is normally the
Merchant Trading Role.
A Consumer should not send a Cancel Block after the IOTP Transaction.
Cancelling a complete should be treated as a technical error.
After cancelling the IOTP Transaction, the Consumer should go to the
net location specified by the CancelNetLocn attribute contained in the
Trading Role Element for the organisation that was sent the Cancel
Block.
A non-Consumer Trading Role should only cancel a transaction:
o after a request block has been received and
o before the response block has been sent
If a non-Consumer Trading Role cancels a transaction at any other time
it should be treated by the recipient is an error.
3.11.2 Handling Cancelled Transactions
If a Cancel Block is received by a Consumer at a point in the IOTP
Transaction when cancellation is allowed, then the Consumer should
stop the transaction.
If a Cancel Block is received by a non-Consumer role, then the Trading
Role should anticipate that the Consumer may go to the location
David Burdett et al. [Page 71]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
specified by the CancelNetLocn attribute contained in the Trading Role
Element for the Trading Role.
David Burdett et al. [Page 72]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
4. IOTP Error Handling
IOTP is designed as a request/response protocol where each message is
composed of a number of Trading Blocks which contain a number of
Trading Components. There are a several interrelated considerations in
handling errors, re-transmissions, duplicates, and the like. These
factors mean IOTP aware applications must manage message flows more
complex than the simple request/response model. Also a wide variety of
errors can occur in messages as well as at the transport level or in
Trading Blocks or Components.
This section describes at a high level how IOTP handles errors,
retries and idempotency. It covers:
o the different types of errors which can occur. This is divided
into:
- "technical errors" which are independent of the meaning of the
IOTP Message,
- "business errors" which indicate that there is a problem specific
to the process (e.g. payment or delivery) which is being carried
out, and
o the depth of the error which indicates whether the error is at
the transport, message or block/component level
o how the different trading roles should handle the different
types of messages which they may receive.
4.1 Technical Errors
Technical Errors are those which are independent of the meaning of the
message. This means, they can affect any attempt at IOTP
communication. Typically they are handled in a standard fashion with a
limited number of standard options for the user. Specifically these
are:
o retrying the transmission, or
o cancelling the transaction.
When communications are operating sufficiently well, a technical error
is indicated by an Error Component (see section 0) in an Error Block
David Burdett et al. [Page 73]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
(see section 7.17) sent by the party which detected the error in an
IOTP message to the party which sent the erroneous message.
If communications are too poor, a message which was sent may not reach
its destination. In this case a time-out might occur.
The Error Codes associated with Technical Errors are recorded in Error
Components 6.19) which lists all the different technical errors which
can be set.
4.2 Business Errors
Business Errors may occur when the IOTP messages are "technically"
correct. They are connected with a particular process, for example, an
offer, payment, delivery or authentication, where each process has a
different set of possible business errors.
For example, "Insufficient funds" is a reasonable payment error but
makes no sense for a delivery while "Back ordered" is a reasonable
delivery error but not meaningful for a payment. Business errors are
indicated in the Status Component (see section 6.14) of a "response
block" of the appropriate type, for example a Payment Response Block
or a Delivery Response Block. This allows whatever additional response
related information is needed to accompany the error indication.
Business errors must usually be presented to the user so that they can
decide what to do next. For example, if the error is insufficient
funds in a Brand Independent Offer (see section 8.1.2.2), the user
might wish to choose a different payment instrument/account of the
same brand or a different brand or payment system. Alternatively, if
the IOTP based implementation allows it and it makes sense for that
instrument, the user might want to put more funds into the
instrument/account and try again.
4.3 Error Depth
The three levels at which IOTP errors can occur are the transport
level, the message level, and the block level. Each is described
below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 74]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
4.3.1 Transport Level
This level of error indicates a fundamental problem in the transport
mechanism over which the IOTP communication is taking place.
All transport level errors are technical errors and are indicated by
either an explicit transport level error indication, such as a "No
route to destination" error from TCP/IP, or by a time out where no
response has been received to a request.
The only reasonable automatic action when faced with transport level
errors is to retry and, after some number of automatic retries, to
inform the user.
The explicit error indications that can be received are transport
dependent and the documentation for appropriate IOTP Transport
supplement should be consulted for errors and appropriate actions.
Appropriate time outs to use are a function of both the transport
being used and of the payment system if the request encapsulates
payment information. The transport and payment system specific
documentation should be consulted for time out and automatic retry
parameters. Frequently there is no way to directly inform the other
party of transport level errors but they should generally be logged
and if automatic recovery is unsuccessful and there is a human user,
the user should be informed.
4.3.2 Message Level
This level of error indicates a fundamental technical problem with an
entire IOTP message. For example, the XML is not _Well Formed_, or the
message is too large for the receiver to handle or there are errors in
the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) so it is not
possible to figure out what transaction the message relates to.
All message level errors are technical errors and are indicated by an
Error Components (see section 6.19) sent to the other party. The Error
Component includes a Severity attribute which indicates whether the
error is a Warning and may be ignored, a TransientError which
indicates that a retry may resolve the problem or a HardError in which
case the transaction must fail.
The Technical Errors (see section 6.19.2 Error Codes) that are Message
Level errors are:
David Burdett et al. [Page 75]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o XML not well formed. The document is not well formed XML (see
[XML])
o XML not valid. The document is not valid XML (see [XML])
o block level technical errors (see section 4.3.3) on the
Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) and the Signature
Block only. Checks on these blocks should only be carried out
if the XML is valid
Note that checks on the Signature Block includes checking, where
possible, that each Signature Component is correctly calculated. If
the Digital Signature Element is incorrectly calculated then the data
that should have been covered by the signature can not be trusted and
must be treated as erroneous. A description of how to check a
signature is correctly calculated is contained in section 5.2 Checking
a Signature is Correctly Calculated.
4.3.3 Block Level
A Block level error indicates a problem with a block or one of its
components in an IOTP message (apart from Transaction Reference or
Signature Blocks). The message has been transported properly, the
overall message structure and the block/component(s) including the
Transaction Reference and Signature Blocks are meaningful but there is
some error related to one of the other blocks.
Block level errors can be either:
o technical errors, or
o business errors
Technical Errors are further divided into:
o Block Level Attribute and Element Checks, and
o Block and Component Consistency Checks
If a technical error occurs related to a block or component, then an
Error Component is returned and, unless it is merely a warning, the
usual response block is suppressed.
David Burdett et al. [Page 76]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
4.3.3.1 Block Level Attribute and Element Checks
Block Level Attribute and Element Checks occur only within the same
block. Checks which involve cross-checking against other blocks are
covered by Block and Component Consistency Checks.
The Block Level Attribute & Element checks are:
o checking that each attribute value within each element in a
block conforms to any rules contained within this IOTP
specification
o checking that the content of each element conforms to any rules
contained within this IOTP specification
o if the previous checks are OK, then checking the consistency of
attribute values and element content against other attribute
values or element content within any other components in the
same block.
4.3.3.2 Block and Component Consistency Checks
Block and Component Consistency Checks consist of:
o checking that the combination of blocks and/or components
present in the IOTP Message are consistent with the rules
contained within this IOTP specification
o checking for consistency between attributes and element content
within the blocks within the same IOTP message.
o checking for consistency between attributes and elements in
blocks in this IOTP message and blocks received in earlier IOTP
messages for the same IOTP transaction
4.3.3.3 Block Business Errors
If a business error occurs in a process such as a Payment or a
Delivery, then the appropriate type of response block is returned. The
Status Component (see section 6.14) within that response block
indicates the error and its severity. No Error Component or Error
Block is generated for business errors.
David Burdett et al. [Page 77]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
4.4 Idempotency, Processing Sequence, and Message Flow
IOTP messages are actually a combination of blocks and components as
described in 3.1.1 IOTP Message Structure. Especially in future
extensions of IOTP, a rich variety of combinations of such blocks and
components can occur. It is important that the multiple
transmission/receipt of the "same" request for state changing action
not result in that action occurring more than once. This is called
idempotency. For example, a customer paying for an order would want to
pay the full amount only once. Most network transport mechanisms have
some probability of delivering a message more than once or not at all,
perhaps requiring retransmission. On the other hand, a request for
status can reasonably be repeated and should be processed fresh each
time it is received.
Correct implementation of IOTP can be modelled by a particular
processing order as detailed below. Any other method that is
indistinguishable in the messages sent between the parties is equally
acceptable.
4.4.1 Server Role Processing Sequence
"Server roles" are any Trading Role which is not the Consumer role.
They are "Server roles" since they typically receive a request which
they must service and then produce a response.
David Burdett et al. [Page 78]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The model processing sequence for a Server role is indicated in the
diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
-------------
| Input |
| IOTP Message|
-------------
|
v
1. Check for transport -------------->
or message level errors Errors |
|OK |
v |
11. Generate output <-------2. More Blocks <----------------- + -
message No to process? | |
| |Yes | |
v v | |
------------- 3. Check Block OK ---------------> | |
| Output | | Errors | |
| IOTP Message| |Checks OK | |
------------- v | |
---------4. Type of Block ? ------- | |
| | | | | |
---------Status Action Encapsulating Error | |
| Request Request Block Block | |
| | | | | |
| v v v | |
| 6a. Action 7. Process 8.Error | |
| Request - encapsulated Block ? | |
| received message and | | |
| before?-- generate -- v | |
| | | response | STOP --- |
| |Yes |No OK| | | |
| v v | |Errors v |
| 6b. Processing 6e. Process Action | ------> 9. Gen |
| of Block Request & generate-+--------->Error |
| Complete ?- response block- | Errors Block & |
| | | ^ | | store |
| | | | | | | |
| |Yes |No | Ok or | | | |
| | --- | Warning | -------- | |
v v v | v | | |
5. Generate 6c. Retrieve 6d. Wait for 6f. Store | | |
Status and resend process request & | | |
Response previous completion response | | |
David Burdett et al. [Page 79]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Block Block block | | |
| | | v v |
---------------------------------------------- 10. Add block--
to output
message
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 10 Server Role Processing Sequence
Each of the processes in the sequence is described in more detail
below.
4.4.1.1 Check for Transport or Message Level Error
On receipt of an IOTP request message (step 1), first check for
transport or message level errors (see sections 4.3.1 and 4.3.2).
These are errors which indicate that the entire message is corrupt and
can not reliably be associated with any particular transaction or, if
it can be associated with a transaction, the interior information in
the message can not be reliably accessed.
If the OtpTransId attribute in the Transaction Id Component (see
section 3.3.1) can be determined, set up a response message with an
appropriate Error Component. Perform local actions such as making log
entries.
If the value of the OtpTransId attribute is not recognised as
belonging to an IOTP transaction when other Blocks in the IOTP Message
indicate that it should be recognised, then report the error using an
Error Component with a Severity of HardError, an ErrorCode set to
AttValNotRecog (attribute value not recognised), and an Error Location
element (see section 6.19.3) that points to the OtpTransId attribute.
No idempotency related actions are necessary.
4.4.1.2 Process all the blocks
If there are no message level errors, process each of the blocks
within the message which has not been processed (step 2).
Once all the blocks have been processed, generate a response message
(step 11) and send it to the requester unless there are fatal
transport level problems. As recommended for the particular transport
used, a limited number of automatic response retransmission attempts
may be appropriate.
David Burdett et al. [Page 80]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
It may be desirable to log the complete response message at the
server. Failure of the requester to receive a response may lead to a
time-out and a retransmission of the request. Following the procedures
above, a duplicate request message should produce a duplicate of the
previous response except for changes in status and transient error
conditions that have changed.
4.4.1.3 Check the Block is OK
Check the block is OK (see section 4.3.3). For each block level
technical error found, an appropriate Error Component should be
created to be included in the IOTP Message sent back to the Consumer.
Note that some checking of the Transaction Reference Block and the
Signature Block has occurred as part of Message Level error checking.
If one or more of the Error Components contain a Severity attribute
with a value of TransientError or HardError, then no response block
need be generated and no further processing of the block, including
idempotency related actions are necessary.
4.4.1.4 Determine the Type of the Block
Trading Blocks that survive the above steps and thus have no errors,
or at worst have added a warning error component to the response, can
receive further processing. The nature of the processing depends (step
4) on whether the block is a Status Request, Action Request, an Error
Block or contains an Encapsulated Message.
4.4.1.5 Status Request Blocks
Status Request Blocks (step 5) are either:
o Inquiry Request Trading Block (see section 7.12), or
o Ping Request Block (see section 7.14).
These status requests do not change state and are processed fresh to
get the current status. The appropriate response block should be added
to the IOTP message being composed.
No idempotency actions are required.
4.4.1.6 Action Request Blocks
Blocks which request an action and change state need to be subject to
idempotency duplicate filtering by checking to see if the same block
David Burdett et al. [Page 81]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
for the same transaction has been previously stored (step 6a) at the
server as described later.
If the Block has been received previously then:
o if processing of the previously stored block is complete (step
6b) then the same IOTP Block as previously produced must be
included for resending to the Consumer (step 6c).
o if processing is not complete, wait until the processing is
complete (step 6d) before sending the response.
If the block has not been received before, the action request is
processed normally (step 6e) producing a response block that is added
to the response message. This might or might not indicate a business
error.
If there is a transient error indicated by an Error Component that
contains a Severity attribute set to TransientError, then apart from
sending the Error Block, no further actions should be taken so the
action can be retried.
If there is no Transient Error, then the transaction id, the request
block, and the response block must be stored (step 6f) so they can be
found as described above (step 6a) should a duplicate IOTP action
request block be received for this transaction in the future.
[Note] Most business errors should be labelled as a TransientError
as there is usually some possibility they will be corrected
over time or some user action exists that can fix them.
Requesters are expected to understand business errors and
the appropriate time scale for user actions for retrying.
[Note End]
4.4.1.7 Encapsulating Blocks
Blocks which encapsulate a payment protocol (step 7) pass along the
enclosed information to the payment system involved.
IOTP does not know the meaning of the enclosed information. It is thus
up to the payment system involved to handle error detection and
idempotency. Payment systems adapted for the Internet include
idempotency handling because duplicates are always possible. Should a
payment system have no idempotency handling, a layer between IOTP and
the payment system must be added to take care of this.
David Burdett et al. [Page 82]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
No IOTP level idempotency actions are required for encapsulating
blocks. The payment system must return material to be encapsulated in
the IOTP response message along with indications as to whether the
exchange will continue or this is the final response and an indication
whether an error occurred. If a payment protocol error has occurred,
an Error Component is added to the response block.
4.4.1.8 Error Block Received
An error block (step 8) should not occur in a request block and should
be treated as an unexpected element with a Severity of HardError.
Error Blocks are sent by Consumers to potentially two locations:
o the _request_ location, i.e. the location from which they
received the IOTP message that contained the error, and
o optionally, the ErrorLogNetLocn which may be a separate
location maintained for the purpose of logging errors
The ErrorLogNetLocn block may be the same location as the _request_
location. In this case, the error block must not considered as a fatal
error.
In order to avoid loops, no Error Block should be sent to the Consumer
in response to an IOTP Message received from a Consumer where the IOTP
message contains an Error Block with a severity of HardError.
4.4.1.9 Generate Error Block
If any of the previous steps resulted in an error being detected and
an Error Component being created then generate an Error Block (step 9)
containing the Error Components that describe the error(s).
Unless the error is a "Transient Error", the Error Component(s) and
the request block which caused the Error Components to be generated
should be stored so that it can be reused if the action request is
received again (step 6a).
"Transient Errors" are not stored so that if the original Response
Block is received again, then it can be processed as if it had never
been received before.
4.4.1.10 Add Block to Output Message
Any Blocks which have been created as a result of processing the block
received are added to the output message.
David Burdett et al. [Page 83]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
4.4.2 Client Role Processing Sequence
The "Client role" in IOTP is the Consumer Trading Role.
[Note] A company or organisation that is a Merchant, for example,
may take on the Trading Role of a Consumer when making a
purchase or downloading or withdrawing electronic cash.
[Note End]
David Burdett et al. [Page 84]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The model processing sequence for a Client role is indicted in the
diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
-------------
| Input |
| IOTP Message|
-------------
|
v
1. Check for transport -->
or message level errors |Errors
|OK |
v |
11.Blocks to be sent?<---------2. More Blocks <-- ------------------
| |No No to process? | ^
Yes| v |Yes | |
v STOP v | |
12. Generate 3. Check Block OK - -->| |
output message | |Errors |
| |Checks OK | |
v v | |
------------- ------ 4. Type of Block ? -----| |
| Output | | | | | | |
| IOTP Message| | ---- | | | |
------------- | | | | | |
------------ | | | | |
| -- | | | |
v v v v | |
Status Action Encapsulating Error | |
Request Response Block Block | |
| | | | | |
| v v v | |
| 6a. Action 7. Process 8a.Error Block---- > Transient |
| Response encapsulated severity ? | Error |
| received message |Hard Error | (retry) |
| before ? | | | | | |
| Yes| |No Ok| | v | WAIT |
| (Ig-| | | | STOP | | |
| nore|) v | | v v |
| | 6b. Process | -------> 9. Generate 8b. |
| | Action | Errors Error Block Retrieve |
| | Response --+----------> & store and resend |
| | Block | Errors | previous |
| | |Ok | | Block(s) |
| | v v | | |
David Burdett et al. [Page 85]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
| | 6c. New | | |
| | request | | |
| | required ? | | |
| | No| |Yes 6d. Generate | | |
| | | ---- > Request | | |
| | | Block & Store v v |
v | | | 10. Add Block to |
----------+-------+------------------------> output message |
v v |
--------------------------------------------------->
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 11 Client Role Processing Sequence
Each of the processes in the sequence is described in more detail below.
4.4.2.1 Check for Transport or Message Level Error
On receipt of an IOTP response message (step 1), first check for
transport or message level errors (see sections 4.3.1 and 4.3.2).
These are errors which indicate that the entire message is corrupt and
can not reliably be associated with any particular transaction or, if
it can be associated with a transaction, the interior information in
the message can not be reliably accessed. Set up an error indication
message with an Error Component indicating the error.
If the value of the OtpTransId attribute is not recognised as
belonging to an IOTP transaction when other Blocks in the IOTP Message
indicate that it should be recognised, then report the error using an
Error Component with a Severity of HardError, an ErrorCode set to
AttValNotRecog (attribute value not recognised), and an Error Location
element (see section 6.19.3) that points to the OtpTransId attribute.
On failure to receive an expected response message, the time out
strategy indicated in the documentation for the transport method being
used should be followed. This may include some number of automatic re-
transmissions of the request. If a user is present, they may be
offered options of continuing to retransmit the request or of
cancelling the transaction.
4.4.2.2 Process all the blocks
If there are no transport or message level errors, process each of the
blocks within the message which has not been processed (step 2).
David Burdett et al. [Page 86]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Once all the blocks have been processed, check to see if there are any
blocks to be sent (step 11). There may be no blocks to send if the
last response message received was the last message of the
transaction.
If blocks are to be sent then generate a request message (step 12) and
send it to the server. It may be desirable to log the complete request
message at the client. Failure of the server to receive a response may
lead to a time-out and a retransmission of the request.
4.4.2.3 Check the Block is OK
If there are no message level errors process each of the blocks within
the message (step 2).
Check the block is OK (see section 4.3.3). For each block level error
found, an appropriate Error Component should be created to be included
in an Error Component sent back to the Server.
If one or more of the Error Components contain a Severity attribute
with a value of TransientError or HardError, no further processing of
the block should occur and it is likely that this will result in
termination of the transaction.
4.4.2.4 Determine the Type of the Block
Trading Blocks that survive the above steps and thus have no errors,
or at worst have added a warning error component to the error
indication message, can receive further processing. The nature of the
processing depends (step 4) on whether the block is a Status Response,
Action Response, an Error Block or contains an Encapsulated Message.
4.4.2.5 Status Response Blocks
Status Response Blocks (step 4) are either:
o Inquiry Response Trading Blocks (see section 7.13), or
o Ping Response Blocks (see section 7.15)
In general, such blocks should be considered a status update. The best
action to take at the requester may depend on whether this is in
response to a user originated or automatic status request, whether a
status display that could be updated is being presented to the user,
and whether the status response block shows a change in status from a
previous response block for the same type of status. Thus client
David Burdett et al. [Page 87]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
detection of duplication in successive status response blocks may be
useful.
4.4.2.6 Action Response Blocks
Check to determine if the Block has been received previously (step
6a). If it has then it should be ignored.
These indicate an action taken at the server in response to an action
request block or a business error. If the response indicates success
the block should be processed (step 6b) and, if required by the
transaction (step 6c), another Action Request Block generated and
stored (step 6d).
The Response Block should always be stored with the transaction id
until the transaction is terminated. If the Response Block indicates a
transient business error, appropriate manually chosen or automatic
steps to fix the problem or cancel the transaction should be provided.
4.4.2.7 Encapsulating Blocks
Blocks which encapsulate a payment protocol (step 7) pass along the
enclosed information to the payment system involved.
IOTP does not know the meaning of the enclosed information. It is up
to the payment system involved to handle error detection and
idempotency. Payment systems adapted for the Internet include
idempotency handling because duplicates are always possible. Should a
payment system have no idempotency handling, a layer between IOTP and
the payment system must be added to take care of this.
No IOTP level idempotency actions are required for encapsulating
blocks. The payment system must return an indication of whether an
error occurred. In addition, for a continuing exchange, it must return
material to be encapsulated in the next IOTP request/exchange (step
6d). If the response was a final response for that payment exchange
and there was an error, the payment system may optionally return
material to be encapsulated in the error indication.
4.4.2.8 Error Block
An error block in a response (step 8a) indicates some problem was
detected by the server. If all of the error components are warnings,
they may be optionally logged and/or presented to the user.
Transient errors may be used to provide a manual or automatic
resending (step 8b) of a block previously stored or alternatively may
David Burdett et al. [Page 88]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
result in transaction cancellation. Hard errors will always terminate
the transaction, unless they are in optional blocks, with appropriate
indication to he user.
4.4.2.9 Generate Error Block
If an error indication message was created above, try to send it to
the unless all of the error components are of the warning severity in
which case attempted transmission to the server is optional.
The net locations consumers send Error Blocks to are:
o the net location which sent them the IOTP Message which was in
error, this is either:
- the location specified by the SenderNetLocn or SecureSenderNetLocn
attribute of the Protocol Options Component if the problem was
contained in the TPO Block or the Offer Response Block
- the location to which the Payment Request Block was sent if the
problem is in either a Payment Exchange or a Payment Response
Block, or
- the location to which the Delivery request Block if the problems
in a Delivery Response Block, and
o if present, the server identified by the ErrorLogNetLocn
attribute of the Trading Role element identified by the
SenderTradingRoleRef the Message Id Component.
4.4.2.10 Add Block to Output Message
Any Blocks which have been created as a result of processing the block
received are added to the output message.
David Burdett et al. [Page 89]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
5. Security Considerations
This section considers the security associated with IOTP. It covers:
o an overview of how IOTP uses digital signatures
o how to check a signature is correctly calculated
o how Payment Handlers and Delivery Handlers check they can carry
out payments or deliveries on behalf of a Merchant.
o how IOTP handles data integrity and privacy
5.1 Digital Signatures and IOTP
In general, signatures when used with IOTP:
o are always treated as a IOTP Components (see section 6)
o contain digests of one or more IOTP Components or Trading
Blocks, possibly including other Signature Components, in any
IOTP message within the same IOTP Transaction
o identify:
- which Organisation signed (originated) the signature, and
- which Organisation(s) should be the receive the signature in order
to check that the Action the Organisation should take can occur.
The way in which Signatures Components digest one or more elements is
illustrated in the figure below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 90]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
IOTP MESSAGE SIGNATURE COMPONENT
IOTP MESSAGE Signature Id = P1.3
|-Trans Ref Block digest TransRefBlk |-Manifest
| | ID=P1.1-----------------------------|->|-Digest of P1.1--
| |-Trans Id Comp digest TransIdComp | | |
| | ID = M1.2----------------------------|->|-Digest of M1.2--|
| |-Msg Id Comp. digest Signature | | |
| | ID = P1 -------------------|->|-Digest of M1.5--|
| | digest element | | |
|-IOTPSignatures Block | -----------------|->|-Digest of M1.7--|
| | ID=P1.2 | | digest element | | |
| |-Signature ID=P1.3 | | ---------------|->|-Digest of C1.4--|
| |-Signature ID=M1.5---- | | | |
| |-Signature ID=P1.4 | | Points to |-RecipientInfo* |
| |-Certificate ID=M1.6<---|-|---------------|---CertRef=M1.6 |
| | | | Certs to use | SignatureValueRef|
| | | | | Points|to Value El|
| | | | | v |
|-Trading Block. ID=P1.5 | | -Value* ID=P1.4: |
| |-Comp. ID=M1.7---------- | JtvwpMdmSfMbhK<--|
| | | r1Ln3vovbMQttbBI |
| |-Comp. ID=P1.6 | J8pxLjoSRfe1o6k|
| | | OGG7nTFzTi+/0<-
| |-Comp. ID=C1.4------------
| |-Comp. ID=C1.5 Digital signature of-
SignedData element
using certificate
identified by CertRef
Elements that are digested can be in any IOTP Message
within the same IOTP Transaction
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 12 Signature Digests
[Note] The classic example of one signature signing another in
IOTP, is when an Offer is first signed by a Merchant
creating an "Offer Response" signature, which is then later
signed by a Payment Handler together with a record of the
payment creating a "Payment Receipt" signature. In this way,
the payment in an IOTP Transaction is bound to the
Merchant's offer.
David Burdett et al. [Page 91]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[Note End]
Note that one Manifest may be associated with multiple signature
"Value" elements where each Value element contains a digital signature
over the same manifest, perhaps using the same (or different)
signature algorithm but using a different certificate
This may be used to allow each potential recipient of a signature to
use different certificates. Specifically it will allow the Merchant to
agreed different shared secrets with their Payment Handler and
Delivery Handler.
The detailed definitions of a Signature component is contained in
section 6.17.
The remainder of this section contains:
o an example of how IOTP uses signatures
o how the OriginatorInfo and RecipientInfo elements within a
Signature Component are used to identify the organisations
associated with the signature
o how signatures may use either Symmetric or Asymmetric
Cryptography
o Mandatory and Optional use of Signatures by IOTP, and
o how IOTP uses signatures to prove actions complete successfully
5.1.1 IOTP Signature Example
An example of how signatures are used is illustrated in the figure
below which shows how the various components and elements in a
Baseline Purchase relate to one another. Refer to this example in the
later description of how signatures are used to check a payment or
delivery can occur (see section 5.3).
[Note] A Baseline Purchase transaction has been used for
illustration purposes. The usage of the elements and
attributes is the same for all types of IOTP Transactions.
[Note End]
David Burdett et al. [Page 92]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
TPO SELECTION BLOCK TPO BLOCK SIGNATURE BLOCK
(Offer Response)
Brand Selection Organisation<--- Signature
Component Component | Component
| | | |
|BrandList -Trading Role | |
| Ref Element | Originator |-Originator
v (Merchant) ------------|--Info
Brand List Ref |
>Component |
| |-Protocol ------> Organisation Recipient |-Recipient
| | Amount Elem | Component <------------------|--Info
| | | | | Refs |
| | Pa|Protocol |Action -Trading Role |
| | | Ref |OrgRef Element |
| | v | (Payment Handler) |
| -PayProtocol-- |
| Elem ->Organisation Recipient |-Recipient
| | Component <-----------------|--Info
| | | Refs |
| | -Trading Role |
| | Element |
| | (Delivery Handler) -Manifest
| | ^
| OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK |
| | Contains digests of:--
|BrandListRef |ActionOrgRef -Trans Ref Block (not
| | shown)
--Payment ---Delivery -Transaction Id Component
Component Component (not shown)
-Org Components (Merchant,
Payment Handler,
Delivery Handler
-Brand List Component
-Order Component
-Payment Component
-Delivery Component
-Brand Selection Component
(if Brand Dependent)
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 13 Example use of Signatures for Baseline Purchase
David Burdett et al. [Page 93]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
5.1.2 OriginatorInfo and RecipientInfo Elements
The OriginatorRef attribute of the OriginatorInfo element in the
Signature Component contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
that points to the Organisation Component of the Organisation which
generated the Signature. In this example its the Merchant.
Note that the value of the content of the Attribute element with a
type attribute set to IOTPSignatureType must match the Trading Role of
the Organisation which signed it. If it does not, then it is an error.
Valid combinations are given in the table below.
IOTP Signature Type Valid Trading Role
OfferResponse Merchant
PaymentResponse PaymentHandler
DeliveryResponse DeliveryHandler
AuthenticationRequest any role
AuthenticationResponse any role
PingRequest any role
PingResponse any role
The RecipientRef attribute of the RecipientInfo element in the
Signature Component contains Element References to the Organisation
Components of the Organisations that should use the signature to
verify that:
o they have a pre-existing relationship with the Organisation
that generated the signature,
o the data which is secured by the signature has not been
changed,
o the data has been signed correctly, and
o the action they are required to undertake on behalf of the
Merchant is therefore authorised.
David Burdett et al. [Page 94]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
5.1.3 Symmetric and Asymmetric Cryptography
The Originator and Recipient of a signature may have agreed to use
cryptography which is understood only by the two organisations
involved. This requires that a separate RecipientInfo and Value
elements are contained within the Signature Component. This approach
is more likely if symmetric cryptography is being used between the
Trading Roles.
Equally the same cryptography may be understood by several or all of
the Trading Roles. In this case the RecpientRefs attribute of one
RecipientInfo element may refer to multiple Organisation Components.
This is more likely if public key/asymmetric cryptography is being
used.
Note that one transaction may involve use of both symmetric and
asymmetric cryptography.
5.1.4 Mandatory and Optional Signatures
IOTP does not mandate the use of signatures. For example, if a micro
payment is being made for 0.1 cents, then the cost of the cryptography
required to generate the signature may be greater than the income
generated from the payment. Therefore it is up to the Merchant to
decide whether IOTP Messages will include signatures, and for the
Consumer to decide whether carrying out a transaction without
signatures is an acceptable risk. If Merchants discover that
transactions without signatures are not being accepted, then they will
start using signatures or accept a lower volume and value of business.
Additional optional signatures, over and above the ones required by
the Trading Roles may be included, for example, to identify a Customer
Care Provider or so that a Merchant can sign an Offer using a
certificate issued by a Certificate Authority which offers Merchant
"Credentials" or some other warranty on the goods or services being
offered.
5.1.5 Using signatures to Prove Actions Complete Successfully
Proving an action completed successfully, is achieved by signing data
on Response messages. Specifically:
o on the Offer Response, when a Merchant is making an Offer to
the Consumer which can then be sent to either:
David Burdett et al. [Page 95]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
- a Payment Handler to prove that the Merchant authorises Payment,
or
- a Delivery Handler to prove that Merchant authorises Delivery,
provided other necessary authorisations are complete (see below)
o on the Payment Response, when a Payment Handler is generating a
Payment Receipt which can be sent to either:
- a Delivery Handler, in a Delivery Request Block to authorise
Delivery together with the Offer Response signature, or
- another Payment Handler, in a second Payment Request, to authorise
the second payment in a Value Exchange IOTP Transaction.
This proof of an action may, in future versions of IOTP, also be used
to prove after the event that the IOTP transaction occurred. For
example to a Customer Care Provider.
5.2 Checking a Signature is Correctly Calculated
Checking a signature is correctly calculated is part of checking for
Message Level Errors (see section 4.3.2). It is included here so that
all signature and security related considerations are kept together.
Before a Trading Role can check a signature it must identify which of
the potentially multiple Signature elements should be checked. The
steps involved are as follows:
o check that a Signature Block is present and it contains one or
more Signature Components
o identify the Organisation Component which contains an OrgId
attribute for the Organisation which is carrying out the
signature check. If no or more than one Organisation Component
is found then it is an error
o use the ID attribute of the Organisation Component to find the
RecipientInfo element that contains a RecipientRefs attribute
that refers to that Organisation Component. Note there may be
no signatures to verify
o check the Signature Component that contains the identified
RecipientInfo element as follows as follows:
- use the SignatureValueRef, the SignatureAlgoritmRef and the
SignatureCertRef attributes to identify: respectively, the Value
element that contains the signature to be checked, the Algorithm
element that describes the signature algorithm to be used to
David Burdett et al. [Page 96]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
verify the Signature and the Certificate to be used by the
signature algorithm, then
- check that the Value Element correctly signs the Manifest Element
- check that the Digest Elements in the Manifest Element are
correctly calculated where Components or Blocks referenced by the
Digest have been received by the organisation checking the
signature
5.3 Checking a Payment or Delivery can occur
This section describes the processes required for a Payment Handler or
Delivery Handler to check that a payment or delivery can occur. This
may include checking signatures if this is specified by the Merchant.
In outline the steps are:
o check that the Payment Request or Delivery Request has been
sent to the correct organisation
o check that correct IOTP components are present in the request,
and
o check that the payment or delivery is authorised
For clarity and brevity the following terms or phrases are used in
this section:
o a "Request Block" is used to refer to either a Payment Request
Block (see section 7.7) or a Delivery Request Block (see
section 7.10) unless specified to the contrary
o a "Response Block" is used to refer to either a Payment
Response Block (see section 7.9) or a Delivery Response Block
(see section 7.11)
o an "Action" is used to refer to an action which occurs on
receipt of a Request Block. Actions can be either a Payment or
a Delivery
o an "Action Organisation", is used to refer to the Payment
Handler or Delivery Handler that carries out an Action
o a "Signer of an Action", is used to refer to the Organisations
that sign data about an Action to authorise the Action, either
in whole or in part
David Burdett et al. [Page 97]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a "Verifier of an Action", is used to refer to the
Organisations that verify data to determine if they are
authorised to carry out the Action
o an ActionOrgRef attribute contains Element References which can
be used to identify the "Action Organisation" that should carry
out an Action
David Burdett et al. [Page 98]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
5.3.1 Check the Action Request was sent to the Correct Organisation
Checking the Action Request was sent to the correct Organisation
varies depending on whether the Action is a Payment or a Delivery.
5.3.1.1 Payment
In outline a Payment Handler checks if it can accept or make a payment
by identifying the Payment Component in the Payment Request Block it
has received, then using the ID of the Payment Component to track
through the Brand List and Brand Selection Components to identify the
Organisation selected by the Consumer and then checking that this
organisation is itself.
The way data is accessed to do this is illustrated in the figure
below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Start
|
v
Brand List<--------------------------+-----------Payment
Component BrandListRef | Component
| |
|-Brand<-------------------------- |
| Element BrandRef | |
| | Brand Selection
| |Protocol Component
| | AmountRefs | |
| v Protocol | |
|-Protocol Amount<---------------- |
| Element---------- AmountRef |
| | | |
| |Currency |Pay |
| | AmountRefs |Protocol |
| v |Ref |
|-Currency Amount | |
| Element<---------|----------------
| |
-PayProtocol<-----
Element---------------------->Organisation
Action Component
OrgRef |
-Trading Role
Element
(Payment Handler)
David Burdett et al. [Page 99]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 14 Checking a Payment Handler can carry out a Payment
Figure 14 Checking a Payment Handler can carry out a Payment
The following describes the steps involved and the checks which need
to be made:
1) Identify the Payment Component (see section 6.8) in the Payment
Request Block that was received.
2) Identify the Brand List and Brand Selection Components for the
Payment Component. This involves:
a) identifying the Brand List Component (see section 6.6) where
the value of its ID attribute matches the BrandListRef
attribute of the Payment Component. If no or more than one
Brand List Component is found there is an error.
b) identifying the Brand Selection Component (see section 6.7)
where the value of its BrandListRef attribute matches the
BrandListRef of the Payment Component. If no or more than one
matching Brand Selection Component is found there is an
error.
3) Identify the Brand, Protocol Amount, Pay Protocol and Currency
Amount elements within the Brand List that have been selected by
the Consumer as follows:
a) the Brand Element (see section 6.6.1) selected is the element
where the value of its Id attribute matches the value of the
BrandRef attribute in the Brand Selection. If no or more than
one matching Brand Element is found then there is an error.
b) the Protocol Amount Element (see section 6.6.2) selected is
the element where the value of its Id attribute matches the
value of the ProtocolAmountRef attribute in the Brand
Selection Component. If no or more than one matching Protocol
Amount Element is found there is an error
c) the Pay Protocol Element (see section 6.6.4) selected is the
element where the value of its Id attribute matches the value
of the PayProtocolRef attribute in the identified Protocol
Amount Element. If no or more than one matching Pay Protocol
Element is found there is an error
David Burdett et al. [Page 100]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
d) the Currency Amount Element (see section 6.6.3) selected is
the element where the value of its Id attribute matches the
value of the CurrencyAmountRef attribute in the Brand
Selection Component. If no or more than one matching Currency
Amount element is found there is an error
4) Check the consistency of the references in the Brand List and
Brand Selection Components:
a) check that an Element Reference exists in the
ProtocolAmountRefs attribute of the identified Brand Element
that matches the Id attribute of the identified Protocol
Amount Element. If no or more than one matching Element
Reference can be found there is an error
b) check that the CurrencyAmountRefs attribute of the identified
Protocol Amount element contains an element reference that
matches the Id attribute of the identified Currency Amount
element. If no or more than one matching Element Reference is
found there is an error.
c) check the consistency of the elements in the Brand List.
Specifically, the selected Brand, Protocol Amount, Pay
Protocol and Currency Amount Elements are all child elements
of the identified Brand List Component. If they are not there
is an error.
5) Check that the Payment Handler that received the Payment Request
Block is the Payment Handler selected by the Consumer. This
involves:
a) identifying the Organisation Component for the Payment
Handler. This is the Organisation Component where its ID
attribute matches the ActionOrgRef attribute in the
identified Pay Protocol Element. If no or more than one
matching Organisation Component is found there is an error
b) checking the Organisation Component has a Trading Role
Element with a Role attribute of PaymentHandler. If not there
is an error
c) finally, if the identified Organisation Component is not the
same as the organisation that received the Payment Request
Block, then there is an error.
David Burdett et al. [Page 101]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
5.3.1.2 Delivery
The way data is accessed by a Delivery Handler in order to check that
it may carry out a delivery is illustrated in the figure below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Start
|
v
Delivery
Component
|
|ActionOrgRef
|
v
Organisation
Component
|
-Trading Role
Element
(Delivery Handler)
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 15 Checking a Delivery Handler can carry out a Delivery
The steps involved are as follows:
1) Identify the Delivery Component in the Delivery Request Block.
If there is no or more than one matching Delivery Component
there is an error
2) Use the ActionOrgRef attribute of the Delivery Component to
identify the Organisation Component of the Delivery Handler. If
there is no or more than one matching Organisation Component
there is an error
3) If the Organisation Component for the Delivery Handler does not
have a Trading Role Element with a Role attribute of
DeliveryHandler there is an error
4) Finally, if the organisation that received the Delivery Request
Block does not identify the Organisation Component for the
Delivery Handler as itself, then there is an error.
David Burdett et al. [Page 102]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
5.3.2 Check the Correct Components are present in the Request Block
Check that the correct components are present in the Payment Request
Block (see section 7.7) or in the Delivery Request Block (see section
7.10).
If components are missing, there is an error.
5.3.3 Check an Action is Authorised
The previous steps identified the Action Organisation and that all the
necessary components are present. This step checks that the Action
Organisation is authorised to carry out the Action.
In outline the Action Organisation identifies the Merchant, checks
that it has a pre-existing agreement which allows it carry out the
Action and that any constraints implied by that agreement are being
followed, then, if signatures are required, it checks that they sign
the correct data.
The steps involved are as follows:
1) Identify the Merchant. This is the Organisation Component with a
Trading Role Element which has a Role attribute with a value of
Merchant. If no or more than one Trading Role Element is found,
there is an error
2) Check the Action Organisation's agreements with the Merchant
allows the Action to be carried out. To do this the Action
Organisation must check that:
a) the Merchant is known and a pre-existing agreement exists for
the Action Organisation to be their agent for the payment or
delivery
b) they are allowed to take part in the type of IOTP transaction
that is occurring. For example a Payment Handler may have
agreed to accept payments as part of a Baseline Purchase, but
not make payments as part of a Baseline Refund
c) any constraints in their agreement with the Merchant are
being followed, for example, whether or not an Offer Response
signature is required
3) Check the signatures are correct. If signatures are required
then they need to be checked. This involves:
David Burdett et al. [Page 103]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
a) Identifying the correct signatures to check. This involves
the Action Organisation identifying the Signature Components
that contain references to the Action Organisation (see
5.3.1). Depending on the IOTP Transaction being carried out
(see section 8) either one or two signatures may be
identified
b) checking that the Signature Components are correct. This
involves checking that Digest elements exist within the
Manifest Element that refer to the necessary Trading
Components (see section 5.3.3.1).
[Note] Validation that the signature is correct and that the Digest
elements within the signature are correctly calculated is
described in section 4 IOTP Error Handling. This is because
errors in the signature or generation of digests is
considered a Message Level Error and is carried out before
the Request Block is processed.
[Note End]
5.3.3.1 Check the Signatures Digests are correct
All Signature Components contained within IOTP Messages must include
Digest elements that refer to:
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP
message that contains the Signature Component. This binds the
globally unique OtpTransId to other components which make up
the IOTP Transaction
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the first
IOTP Message that contained the signature. This binds the
OtpTransId with information about the IOTP Message contained
inside the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2).
Check that each Signature Component contains Digest elements that
refer to the correct data required.
The Digest elements that need to be present depend on the Trading Role
of the Organisation which generated (signed) the signature:
o if the signer of the signature is a Merchant then:
- Digest elements must be present for all the components in the
Request Block apart from the Brand Selection Component which is
optional
David Burdett et al. [Page 104]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o if the signer of the signature is a Payment Handler then Digest
elements must be present for:
- the Signature Component signed by the Merchant, and optionally
- one or more Signature Components signed by the previous Payment
Handler(s) in the Transaction.
5.4 Data Integrity and Privacy
The overall integrity of data in IOTP Messages is ensured by the
signing of Digests of Components and Trading Blocks contained in a
Signature Component (see section 6.17) in a Signature Block (see
section 7.16).
Privacy of information is provided by sending IOTP Messages between
the various Trading Roles using a secure channel such as [SSL]. Use of
a secure channel within IOTP is optional.
David Burdett et al. [Page 105]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6. Trading Components
This section describes the Trading Components used within IOTP.
Trading Components are the child XML elements which occur immediately
below a Trading Block as illustrated in the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 106]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
IOTP MESSAGE <----------- IOTP Message - an XML Document
| which is transported between the
| Trading Roles
|-Trans Ref Block <----- Trans Ref Block - contains
| | information which describes the
| | IOTP Transaction and the IOTP
Message.
--------> | |-Trans Id Comp. <--- Transaction Id Component -
| | | uniquely identifies the IOTP
| | | Transaction. The Trans Id
| | | Components are the same across
| | | all IOTP messages that comprise
| | | a single IOTP transaction.
| | |-Msg Id Comp. <----- Message Id Component -
| | identifies and describes an IOTP
| | Message within an IOTP
| | Transaction
| |-Signature Block <----- Signature Block (optional) -
| | | contains one or more Signature
| | | Components and their associated
| | | Certificates
| ---> | |-Signature Comp. <-- Signature Component - contains
| | | | digital signatures. Signatures
| | | | may sign digests of the Trans Ref
| | | | Block and any Trading Component
| | | | in any IOTP Message in the same
| | | | IOTP Transaction.
| | | |-Certificate Comp. <- Certificate Component. Used to
| | | check the signature.
Trading |-Trading Block <-------- Trading Block - an XML Element
Components | |-Component within an IOTP Message that
| | | |-Component contains a predefined set of
| ---> | |-Component Trading Components
| | |-Component
| | |-Component <--------- Trading Components - XML
| | Elements within a Trading Block
| |-Trading Block that contain a predefined set of
--------> | |-Component XML elements and attributes
| |-Component containing information required
| |-Component to support a Trading Exchange
| |-Component
| |-Component
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 16 Trading Components
David Burdett et al. [Page 107]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The Trading Components described in this section are listed below in
approximately the sequence they are likely to be used:
o Protocol Options Component
o Authentication Data Component
o Authentication Response Component
o Order Component
o Organisation Component
o Brand List Component
o Brand Selection Component
o Payment Component
o Payment Scheme Component
o Payment Receipt Component
o Delivery Component
o Delivery Note Component
o Signature Component
o Certificate Component
o Error Component
Note that the following components are listed in other sections of
this specification:
o Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1)
o Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2)
6.1 Protocol Options Component
Protocol options are options which apply to the IOTP Transaction as a
whole. Essentially it provides a short description of the entire
David Burdett et al. [Page 108]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
transaction and the net location which the Consumer role should branch
to if the IOTP Transaction is successful.
The definition of a Protocol Options Component is as follows.
<!ELEMENT ProtocolOptions EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST ProtocolOptions
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
SenderNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
SecureSenderNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
SuccessNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Protocol Options Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
Xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or
child elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
ShortDesc This contains a short description of the IOTP
Transaction in the language defined by
xml:lang. Its purpose is to provide an
explanation of what type of IOTP Transaction is
being conducted by the parties involved.
It is used to facilitate selecting an
individual transaction from a list of similar
transactions, for example from a database of
IOTP transactions which has been stored by a
Consumer, Merchant, etc.
SenderNetLocn This contains the non secured net location of
the sender of the TPO Block in which the
Protocol Options Component is contained.
It is the net location to which the recipient
of the TPO block should send a TPO Selection
Block if required.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
David Burdett et al. [Page 109]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Mechanism Supplement.
SecureSenderNetLocn This contains the secured net location of the
sender of the TPO Block in which the Protocol
Options Component is contained.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
Mechanism Supplement.
SuccessNetLocn This contains the net location that the should
be displayed after the IOTP Transaction has
successfully completed.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
Mechanism Supplement.
Either SenderNetLocn, SecureSenderNetLocn or both must be present.
6.2 Authentication Data Component
This Trading Component contains data about how an Authentication
within the IOTP Transaction will occur. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT AuthData (PackagedContent+, Algorithm+)>
<!ATTLIST AuthData
ID ID #REQUIRED
AuthenticationId CDATA #REQUIRED
TradingRoleList NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AlgorithmRefs IDREFS #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Authentication Data Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
AuthenticationId An identifier specified by the Authenticator
which, if returned by the Organisation that
receives the Authentication Request, will enable
the Authenticator to identify which
Authentication is being referred to.
David Burdett et al. [Page 110]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
AlgorithmRefs This contains a list of the Algorithm Elements
contained within the Auth Data Component from
which the recipient of the AuthData Component
must choose one to use to generate the
Authentication Response (see section 6.3). Note
there only one Algorithm may be present.
TradingRoleList If present, contains a list of the Trading Roles
(see the TradingRole attribute of the Trading
Role Element - section 6.5.2) for which the
Authenticator is requesting the Authenticatee
provides Organisation Components in the
Authentication Response.
For example a Merchant could request that a
Consumer provides Organisation Components for
the Consumer and DelivTo Trading Roles.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent This contains the challenge data as one or more
Packaged Content (see section 3.8) that is to be
responded to using the method indicated by
AuthMethod.
Algorithm This contains information which describes an
Algorithm (see 6.17 Signature Components) that
David Burdett et al. [Page 111]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
may be used to generate the Authentication
Response.
6.3 Authentication Response Component
This Authentication Response Component contains the results of an
authentication. It uses one of the Algorithms selected contained in
the AuthData Component (see section 6.2). Depending on the Algorithm
selected, the results of the applying the algorithm will either be
contained in a Signature Component that signs the Authentication
Response and other data, or in the Packaged Content element within the
Authentication Response Component. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT AuthResp (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST AuthResp
ID ID #REQUIRED
SelectedAlgorithmRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Authentication Response Component within the
IOTP Transaction.
SelectedAlgorithmRef An Element Reference that identifies the
Algorithm used in generating the
Authentication Response. It must be one of the
Element References contained within the
AlgorithmRefs attribute of the Authentication
Data Component (see section 6.2)
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as
a result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by
xml:lang. It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
David Burdett et al. [Page 112]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the
SoftwareId attribute on the Message Id
Component (see section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent This may contain the response generated as a
result of applying the Algorithm selected from
the Authentication Data Component see section
6.2.
For example, for a payment specific scheme, it
may contain scheme-specific data. Refer to the
scheme-specific supplemental documentation.
6.4 Order Component
An Order Component contains information about an order. Its definition
is as follows.
<!ELEMENT Order (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST Order
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrderIdentifier CDATA #REQUIRED
ShortDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
OkFrom CDATA #REQUIRED
OkTo CDATA #REQUIRED
ApplicableLaw CDATA #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Order Component within the IOTP Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
OrderIdentifier This is a code, reference number or other
David Burdett et al. [Page 113]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
identifier which the creator of the Order may
use to identify the order. It must be unique
within an IOTP Transaction. If it is used in
this way, then it may remove the need to specify
any content for the Order element as the
reference can be used to look up the necessary
information in a database.
ShortDesc A short description of the order in the language
defined by xml:lang. It is used to facilitate
selecting an individual order from a list of
orders, for example from a database of orders
which has been stored by a Consumer, Merchant,
etc.
OkFrom The date and time in [UTC] format after which
the offer made by the Merchant lapses.
OkTo The date and time in [UTC] format before which a
Value Acquirer may accept the offer made by the
Merchant is not valid.
ApplicableLaw A phrase in the language defined by xml:lang
which describes the state or country of
jurisdiction which will apply in resolving
problems or disputes.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
David Burdett et al. [Page 114]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
PackagedContent An optional description of the order information
as one or more Packaged Contents (see section
3.8).
6.4.1 Order Description Content
The Packaged Content element will normally be required, however it may
be omitted where sufficient information about the purchase can be
provided in the ShortDesc attribute. If the full Order Description
requires it several Packaged Content elements may be used.
Although the amount and currency are likely to appear in the Packaged
Content of the Order Description it is the amount and currency
contained in the payment related trading components (Brand List, Brand
Selection and Payment) that is authoritative. This means it is
important that the amount actually being paid (as contained in the
payment related trading components) is prominently displayed to the
Consumer.
For interoperability, implementations must support Plain Text and HTML
as a minimum so that it can be easily displayed.
6.4.2 OkFrom and OkTo Timestamps
Note that:
o the OkFrom date may be later than the OkFrom date on the
Payment Component (see section 6.8) associated with this order,
and
o similarly, the OkTo date may be earlier that the OkTo date on
the Payment Component (see section 6.8).
[Note] Disclaimer. The following information provided in this note
does not represent formal advice of the Open Trading
Protocol Consortium, any of its members or the authors of
this specification. Readers of this specification must form
their own views and seek their own legal counsel on the
usefulness and applicability of this information.
The merchant in the context of Internet commerce with
anonymous consumers initially frames the terms of the offer
on the web page, and in order to obtain the good or service,
the consumer must accept them.
David Burdett et al. [Page 115]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
If there is to be a time-limited offer, it recommended that
merchants communicate this to the consumer and state in the
order description in a manner which is clear to the consumer
that:
o the offer is time limited
o the OkFrom and OkTo timestamps specify the validity of the
offer
o the clock, e.g. the merchant's clock, that will be used to
determine the validity of the offer
[Note End]
6.5 Organisation Component
The Organisation Component provides information about an individual or
an organisation. This can be used for a variety of purposes. For
example:
o to describe the merchant who is selling the goods,
o to identify who made a purchase,
o to identify who will take delivery of goods,
o to provide a customer care contact,
o to describe who will be the Payment Handler.
Note that the Organisation Components which must be present in an OTP
Message are dependent on the particular transaction being carried out.
Refer to section 8. Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions, for
more details.
Its definition is as follows.
David Burdett et al. [Page 116]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT Org (TradingRole+, ContactInfo?,
PersonName?, PostalAddress?)>
<!ATTLIST Org
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrgId CDATA #REQUIRED
OtpMsgIdPrefix NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
LegalName CDATA #IMPLIED
ShortDesc CDATA #IMPLIED
LogoNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Organisation Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
OrgId A code which identifies the organisation
described by the Organisation Component. See
6.5.1.1 Organisation IDs, below.
OtpMsgIdPrefix Contains the prefix which must be used for all
IOTP Messages sent by the Organisation in this
IOTP Transaction. The values to be used are
defined in 3.4.1 IOTP Message ID Attribute
Definition.
LegalName For organisations which are companies this is
their legal name in the language defined by
xml:lang. It is required for Organisations who
have a Trading Role other than Consumer or
DeliverTo.
ShortDesc A short description of the organisation in the
language defined by xml:lang. It is typically
the name by which the organisation is commonly
known. For example, if the legal name was "Blue
Meadows Financial Services Inc.". Then its short
name would likely be "Blue Meadows".
It is used to facilitate selecting an individual
David Burdett et al. [Page 117]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
organisation from a list of organisations, for
example from a database of organisations
involved in IOTP Transactions which has been
stored by a consumer.
LogoNetLocn The net location which can be used to download
the logo for the organisation.
See section 9 Retrieving Logos.
The content of this attribute must conform to
[RFC1738].
Content:
TradingRole See 6.5.2 Trading Role Element below.
ContactInfo See 6.5.3 Contact Information Element below.
PersonName See 6.5.4 Person Name below.
PostalAddress See 6.5.5 Postal Address below.
6.5.1.1 Organisation IDs
Organisation IDs are used by one IOTP Trading Role to identify
another. In order to avoid confusion, this means that these IDs must
be globally unique.
In principle this is achieved in the following way:
o the Organisation Id for all trading roles, apart from the
Consumer Trading Role, uses a domain name as their globally
unique identifier,
o the Organisation Id for a Consumer Trading Role is allocated by
one of the other Trading Roles in an IOTP Transaction and is
made unique by concatenating it with that other roles'
Organisation Id,
o once a Consumer is allocated an Organisation Id within an IOTP
Transaction the same Organisation Id is used by all the other
trading roles in that IOTP transaction to identify that
Consumer.
Specifically, the content of the Organisation ID is defined as
follows:
David Burdett et al. [Page 118]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
OrgId ::= NonConsumerOrgId | ConsumerOrgId
NonConsumerOrgId ::= DomainName
ConsumerOrgId ::= ConsumerOrgIdPrefix (namechar)+ "/"
NonConsumerOrgId
ConsumerOrgIdPrefix ::= "Consumer:"
ConsumerOrgId If the Organisation ID for a Consumer consists
of:
o a standard prefix is to identify that the
Organisation Id is for a consumer, followed by
o one or more characters which conform to the
definition of an XML "namechar". See [XML]
specifications, followed by
o the NonConsumerOrgId for the Organisation
which allocated the ConsumerOrgId. It is
normally the Merchant role.
Use of upper and lower case is significant.
NonConsumerOrgId If the Role is not Consumer then this contains
the Canonical Name for the non-consumer
organisation being described by the Organisation
Component. See [DNS].
Note that a NonConsumerOrgId may not start with
the ConsumerOrgIdPrefix.
Use of upper and lower case is not significant.
Examples of Organisation Ids follow:
o newjerseybooks.com - a merchant organisation id
o westernbank.co.uk - a payment handler organisation id
o consumer:1000247ABH/newjerseybooks.com - a consumer
organisation id allocated by a merchant
6.5.2 Trading Role Element
This identifies the Trading Role of an individual or organisation in
the IOTP Transaction. Note, an organisation may have more than one
Trading Role and several roles may be present in one organisation
element. Its definition is as follows:
David Burdett et al. [Page 119]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT TradingRole EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST TradingRole
ID ID #REQUIRED
TradingRole NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CancelNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
ErrorNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
ErrorLogNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Trading Role Element within the IOTP
Transaction.
TradingRole The trading role of the organisation. Valid
values are:
o Consumer. The person or organisation that is
acting in the role of a consumer in the IOTP
Transaction.
o Merchant. The person or organisation that is
acting in the role of merchant in the IOTP
Transaction.
o PaymentHandler. The financial institution or
other organisation which is a Payment Handler
for the IOTP Transaction
o DeliveryHandler. The person or organisation
that is the delivering the goods or services
for the IOTP Transaction
o DelivTo. The person or organisation that is
receiving the delivery of goods or services in
the IOTP Transaction
o CustCare. The organisation and/or individual
who will provide customer care for an IOTP
Transaction.
Values of TradingRole are controlled under the
procedures defined in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes which also allows user defined values
to be defined.
CancelNetLocn This contains the net location of where the
Consumer should go to if the Consumer cancels
the transaction for some reason. It can be used
by the Trading Role to provide a response which
is more tailored to the circumstances of a
particular transaction.
David Burdett et al. [Page 120]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
This attribute:
o must not be present when TradingRole is set to
Consumer role,
o must be present when TradingRole is set to
Merchant, PaymentHandler or DeliveryHandler.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
Mechanism Supplement.
ErrorNetLocn This contains the net location that should be
displayed by the Consumer after the Consumer has
either received or generated an Error Block
containing an Error Component with the Severity
attribute set to either:
o HardError,
o Warning but the Consumer decides to not
continue with the transaction
o TransientError and the transaction has
subsequently timed out.
See section 6.19.1 Error Processing Guidelines
for more details.
This attribute:
o must not be present when TradingRole is set to
Consumer role,
o must be present when TradingRole is set to
Merchant, PaymentHandler or DeliveryHandler.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
Mechanism Supplement.
ErrorLogNetLocn Optional. This contains the net location that
Consumers should send IOTP Messages that contain
Error Blocks with an Error Component with the
Severity attribute set to either:
o HardError,
o Warning but the Consumer decides to not
continue with the transaction
o TransientError and the transaction has
subsequently timed out.
This attribute:
o must not be present when TradingRole is set to
David Burdett et al. [Page 121]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Consumer role,
o must be present when TradingRole is set to
Merchant, PaymentHandler or DeliveryHandler.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
Mechanism Supplement.
The ErrorLogNetLocn can be used to send error
messages to the software company or some other
organisation responsible for fixing problems in
the software which sent the incoming message.
See section 6.19.1 Error Processing Guidelines
for more details.
6.5.3 Contact Information Element
This contains information which can be used to contact an organisation
or an individual. All attributes are optional however at least one
item of contact information should be present. Its definition is as
follows.
<!ELEMENT ContactInfo EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST ContactInfo
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Tel CDATA #IMPLIED
Fax CDATA #IMPLIED
Email CDATA #IMPLIED
NetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within
this element. See section 3.9 Identifying
Languages.
Tel A telephone number by which the organisation may
be contacted. Note that this is a text field and
no validation is carried out on it.
Fax A fax number by which the organisation may be
contacted. Note that this is a text field and no
validation is carried out on it.
Email An email address by which the organisation may
be contacted. Note that this field should
David Burdett et al. [Page 122]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
conform to the conventions for address
specifications contained in [RFC822].
NetLocn A location on the Internet by which information
about the organisation may be obtained that can
be displayed using a web browser.
The content of this attribute must conform to
[RFC1738].
6.5.4 Person Name Element
This contains the name of an individual person. All fields are
optional however as a minimum either the GivenName or the FamilyName
should be present. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT PersonName EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST PersonName
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Title CDATA #IMPLIED
GivenName CDATA #IMPLIED
Initials CDATA #IMPLIED
FamilyName CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within
this element. See section 3.9 Identifying
Languages.
Title A distinctive name; personal appellation,
hereditary or not, denoting or implying office
(e.g. judge, mayor) or nobility (e.g. duke,
duchess, earl), or used in addressing or
referring to a person (e.g. Mr, Mrs, Miss)
GivenName The primary or main name by which a person is
known amongst and identified by their family,
friends and acquaintances. Otherwise known as
first name or Christian Name.
Initials The first letter of the secondary names (other
than the Given Name) by which a person is known
amongst or identified by their family, friends
and acquaintances.
David Burdett et al. [Page 123]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
FamilyName The name by which family of related individuals
are known. It is typically the part of an
individual's name which is passed on by parents
to their children.
6.5.5 Postal Address Element
This contains an address which can be used, for example, for the
physical delivery of goods, services or letters. Its definition is as
follows.
<!ELEMENT PostalAddress EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST PostalAddress
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AddressLine1 CDATA #IMPLIED
AddressLine2 CDATA #IMPLIED
CityOrTown CDATA #IMPLIED
StateOrRegion CDATA #IMPLIED
PostalCode CDATA #IMPLIED
Country CDATA #IMPLIED
LegalLocation (True | False) 'False' >
Attributes:
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within
this element. See section 3.9 Identifying
Languages.
AddressLine1 The first line of a postal address. e.g. "The
Meadows"
AddressLine2 The second line of a postal address. e.g. "Sandy
Lane"
CityOrTown The city of town of the address. e.g. "Carpham"
StateOrRegion The state or region within a country where the
city or town is placed. e.g. "Surrey"
Country The country for the address. e.g. "UK"
LegalLocation This identifies whether the address is the
Registered Address for the Organisation. At
least one address for the Organisation must have
a value set to True unless the Trading Role is
David Burdett et al. [Page 124]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
either Consumer or DeliverTo.
6.6 Brand List Component
Brand List Components are contained within the Trading Protocol
Options Block (see section 7.1) of the IOTP Transaction. They contains
lists of:
o payment Brands (see also section 3.6 Brands and Brand
Selection),
o amounts to be paid in the currencies that are accepted or
offered by the Merchant,
o the payment protocols which can be used to make payments with a
Brand, and
o the net locations of the Payment Handlers which accept payment
for a payment protocol
The definition of a Brand List Component is as follows.
<!ELEMENT BrandList (Brand+, ProtocolAmount+,
CurrencyAmount+, PayProtocol+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandList
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
PayDirection (Debit | Credit) #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Brand List Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
ShortDesc A text description in the language defined by
xml:Lang giving details of the purpose of the
Brand List. This information must be displayed
to the receiver of the Brand List in order to
David Burdett et al. [Page 125]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
assist with making the selection. It is of
particular benefit in allowing a Consumer to
distinguish the purpose of a Brand List when an
IOTP Transaction involves more than one payment.
PayDirection Indicates the direction in which the payment for
which a Brand is being selected is to be made.
Its values may be:
o Debit The sender of the Payment Request Block
(e.g. the Consumer) to which this Brand List
relates will make the payment to the Payment
Handler, or
o Credit The sender of the Payment Request Block
to which this Brand List relates will receive
a payment from the Payment Handler.
Content:
Brand This describes a Brand. The sequence of the
Brand elements (see section 6.6.1) within the
Brand List does not indicate any preference. It
is recommended that software which processes
this Brand List presents Brands in a sequence
which the receiver of the Brand List prefers.
ProtocolAmount This links a particular Brand to:
o the currencies and amounts in CurrencyAmount
elements that can be used with the Brand, and
o the Payment Protocols and Payment Handlers,
which can be used with those currencies and
amounts, and a particular Brand
CurrencyAmount This contains a currency code and an amount.
PayProtocol This contains information about a Payment
Protocol and the Payment Handler which may be
used with a particular Brand.
David Burdett et al. [Page 126]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The relationships between the elements which make up the content of
the Brand List is illustrated in the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Brand List
Component
|
|-Brand
| Element
| |
| |Protocol
| | AmountRefs
| v
|-Protocol Amount
| Element----------
| | |
| |Currency |Pay
| | AmountRefs |Protocol
| v |Ref
|-Currency Amount |
| Element |
| |
-PayProtocol<-----
Element
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 17 Brand List Element Relationships
Examples of complete Brand Lists are contained in section 10 Brand
List Examples.
6.6.1 Brand Element
A Brand Element describes a brand that can be used for making a
payment. One or more of these elements is carried in each Brand List
Component that has the PayDirection attribute set to Debit. Exactly
one Brand Element may be carried in a Brand List Component that has
the PayDirection attribute set to Credit.
David Burdett et al. [Page 127]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT Brand (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST Brand
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
BrandId NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BrandName CDATA #REQUIRED
BrandLogoNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
BrandNarrative CDATA #IMPLIED
ProtocolAmountRefs IDREFS #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
Id Element identifier, potentially referenced in a
Brand Selection Component contained in a later
Payment Request message and uniquely identifies
the Brand element within the IOTP Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes and
content of this element. See section 3.9
Identifying Languages.
BrandId This contains a unique identifier for the brand
or promotional brand. It is used to match
against a list of Payment Instruments which the
Consumer holds to determine whether or not the
Consumer can pay with the Brand.
The syntax for a BrandId is as follows:
BrandId ::= BrandIdDomain ":" BrandValue
Currently the two valid values for the
BrandIdDomain have been defined:
o IOTP which indicates that values of BrandValue
are managed under the procedure described in
section 3.7.3 Values for IOTP Codes, and
o SET which indicates that the BrandValue
conforms to [SET] conventions
Examples of BrandIds are: IOTP:Mondex,
SET:MasterCard::, and
SET:Visa:Gold:AmericanAirlines. The first
BrandId is an example of an IOTP BrandId, and
the following two are SET BrandIds.
David Burdett et al. [Page 128]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
As values of BrandId are controlled under the
procedures defined in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes user defined values may be defined.
BrandName This contains the name of the brand, for example
MasterCard Credit. This is the description of
the Brand which is displayed to the consumer in
the Consumers language defined by xml:lang. For
example it might be "American Airlines Advantage
Visa". Note that this attribute is not used for
matching against the payment instruments held by
the Consumer.
BrandLogoNetLocn The net location which can be used to download
the logo for the organisation. See section
Retrieving Logos (see section 9).
The content of this attribute must conform to
[RFC1738].
BrandNarrative This optional attribute is designed to be used
by the Merchant to indicate some special
conditions or benefit which would apply if the
Consumer selected that brand. For example "5%
discount", "free shipping and handling", "free
breakage insurance for 1 year", "double air
miles apply", etc.
ProtocolAmountRefs Identifies the protocols and related currencies
and amounts which can be used with this Brand.
Specified as a list of ID's of Protocol Amount
Elements (see section 6.6.2) contained within
the Brand List.
ContentSoftwareId This optional attribute contains information
which identifies the software which generated
the content of the element. Its purpose is to
help resolve interoperability problems that
might occur as a result of incompatibilities
between messages produced by different software.
It is a single text string in the language
defined by xml:lang. It must contain, as a
minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
David Burdett et al. [Page 129]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content (see section 3.8)
elements containing information about the brand
which may be used by the payment protocol. The
content of this information is defined in the
supplement for a payment protocol which
describes how the payment protocol works with
IOTP.
Examples Brand Elements are contained in section 10 Brand List
Examples.
6.6.2 Protocol Amount Element
The Protocol Amount element links a Brand to:
o the currencies and amounts in Currency Amount Elements (see
section 6.6.3) that can be used with the Brand, and
o the Payment Protocols and Payment Handlers defined in a Pay
Protocol Element (see section 6.6.4), which can be used with
those currencies and amounts.
Its definition is as follows:
<!ELEMENT ProtocolAmount (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST ProtocolAmount
ID ID #REQUIRED
PayProtocolRef IDREF #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRefs IDREFS #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
Id Element identifier, potentially referenced in a
Brand element; or in a Brand Selection Component
contained in a later Payment Request message
David Burdett et al. [Page 130]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
which uniquely identifies the Protocol Amount
element within the IOTP Transaction.
PayProtocolRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
that refers to the Pay Protocol Element (see
section 6.6.4) that contains the Payment
Protocol and Payment Handlers that can be used
with the Brand.
CurrencyAmountRefs Contains a list of Element References (see
section 3.5) that refer to the Currency Amount
Element (see section 6.6.3) that describes the
currencies and amounts that can be used with the
Brand.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content (see section 3.8)
elements containing information about the
protocol amount which may be used by the payment
protocol. The content of this information is
defined in the supplement for a payment protocol
which describes how the payment protocol works
with IOTP.
Examples of Protocol Amount Elements are contained in10 Brand List
Examples.
David Burdett et al. [Page 131]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.6.3 Currency Amount Element
A Currency Amount element contains:
o a currency code (and its type), and
o an amount.
One or more of these elements is carried in each Brand List Component.
Its definition is as follows:
<!ELEMENT CurrencyAmount EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST CurrencyAmount
ID ID #REQUIRED
Amount CDATA #REQUIRED
CurrCodeType NMTOKEN 'ISO4217'
CurrCode CDATA #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
Id Element identifier, potentially referenced in a
Brand element; or in a Brand Selection Component
contained in a later Payment Request message
which uniquely identifies the Currency Amount
Element within the IOTP Transaction.
Amount Indicates the amount to be paid in whole and
fractional units of the currency. For example
$245.35 would be expressed "245.35". Note that
values smaller than the smallest denomination
are allowed. For example one tenth of a cent
would be "0.001".
CurrCodeType Indicates the domain of the CurrCode. This
attribute is included so that the currency code
may support non-standard "currencies" such as
frequent flyer points, trading stamps, etc. Its
values may be:
. ISO4217 indicates the currency code conforms
to [ISO 4217]
. IOTP indicates that values of CurrCode are
managed under the procedure described in
section 3.7.3 Values for IOTP Codes
CurrCode A code which identifies the currency to be used
in the payment. The domain of valid currency
codes is defined by CurrCodeType
David Burdett et al. [Page 132]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
As values of CurrCodeType are managed under the
procedure described in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes user defined values of CurrCodeType
may be defined.
Examples of Currency Amount Elements are contained in 10 Brand List
Examples.
6.6.4 Pay Protocol Element
A Pay Protocol element specifies details of a Payment Protocol and the
Payment Handler that can be used with a Brand. One or more of these
elements is carried in each Brand List.
<!ELEMENT PayProtocol (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST PayProtocol
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProtocolId NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolName CDATA #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReqNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
SecPayReqNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
Id Element identifier, potentially referenced in a
Brand element; or in a Brand Selection Component
contained in a later Payment Request message
which uniquely identifies the Pay Protocol
element within the IOTP Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes and
content of this element. See section 3.9
Identifying Languages.
ProtocolId Consists of a protocol name and version. For
example "SETv1.0".
Values of ProtocolId are managed under the
procedure described in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes.
Each payment supplement defines the value to be
David Burdett et al. [Page 133]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
used with that payment method.
ProtocolName A narrative description of the payment protocol
and its version in the language identified by
xml:lang. For example "Secure Electronic
Transaction Version 1.0". Its purpose is to help
provide information on the payment protocol
being used if problems arise.
ActionOrgRef An Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the
Organisation Component for the Payment Handler
for the Payment Protocol.
PayReqNetLocn The Net Location indicating where an unsecured
Payment Request message should be sent if this
protocol choice is used.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism (such must conform to
[RFC1738].
SecPayReqNetLocn The Net Location indicating where a secured
Payment Request message should be sent if this
protocol choice is used.
A secured payment involves the use of a secure
channel such as [SSL] in order to communicate
with the Payment Handler.
The content of this attribute must conform to
[RFC1738]. See also See section 3.10 Secure and
Insecure Net Locations.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
David Burdett et al. [Page 134]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content elements (see section
3.8) containing information about the protocol
which is used by the payment protocol. The
content of this information is defined in the
supplement for a payment protocol which
describes how the payment protocol works with
IOTP. An example of its use could be to include
a payment protocol message.
Examples of Pay Protocol Elements are contained in section 6.6 Brand
List Component.
6.7 Brand Selection Component
A Brand Selection Component identifies the choice of payment brand,
payment protocol and the Payment Handler. This element is used:
o in Payment Request messages within Baseline Purchase and
Baseline Value IOTP Transactions to identify the brand,
protocol and payment handler for a payment, or
o to, optionally, inform a merchant in a purchase of the payment
brand being used so that the offer and order details can be
amended accordingly.
In Baseline IOTP, the integrity of Brand Selection Components is not
guaranteed. However, modification of Brand Selection Components can
only cause denial of service if the payment protocol itself is secure
against message modification, duplication, and swapping attacks.
The definition of a Brand Selection Component is as follows.
David Burdett et al. [Page 135]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT BrandSelection (BrandSelBrandInfo?,
BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo?,
BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo?) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelection
ID ID #REQUIRED
BrandListRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BrandRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolAmountRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Brand Selection Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
BrandListRef The Element Reference (see section 3.5) of the
Brand List Component from which a Brand is being
selected
BrandRef The Element Reference of a Brand element within
the Brand List Component that is being selected
that is to be used in the payment.
ProtocolAmountRef The Element Reference of a Protocol Amount
element within the Brand List Component which is
to be used when making the payment.
CurrencyAmountRef The Element Reference of a Currency Amount
element within the Brand List Component which is
to be used when making the payment.
Content:
BrandSelBrandInfo, This contains any additional data that may be
BrandSelProtocolAm required by a particular payment brand or
ountInfo, protocol. See sections 6.7.1, 6.7.2, and 6.7.3.
BrandSelCurrencyAm
ountInfo
The following rules apply:
o the BrandListRef must contain the ID of a Brand List Component
in the same IOTP Transaction
David Burdett et al. [Page 136]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o every Brand List Component in the Trading Protocol Options
Block must be referenced by one and only one Brand Selection
Component
o the BrandRef must refer to the ID of a Brand contained within
the Brand List Component referred to by BrandListRef
o the ProtocolAmountRef must refer to one of the Element IDs
listed in the ProtocolAmountRefs attribute of the Brand
element identified by BrandRef
o the CurrencyAmountRef must refer to one of the Element IDs
listed in the CurrencyAmountRefs attribute of the Protocol
Amount Element identified by ProtocolAmountRef.
An example of a Brand Selection Component is included in 10 Brand List
Examples.
6.7.1 Brand Selection Brand Info Element
The Brand Selection Brand Info Element contains any additional data
that may be required by a particular payment brand. See the IOTP
payment method supplement for a description of how and when it used.
<!ELEMENT BrandSelBrandInfo (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelBrandInfo
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
David Burdett et al. [Page 137]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Packaged Content elements (see section 3.8) that
contain additional data that may be required by
a particular payment brand. See the payment
method supplement for IOTP for rules on how this
is used.
6.7.2 Brand Selection Protocol Amount Info Element
The Brand Selection Protocol Amount Info Element contains any
additional data that is payment protocol specific that may be required
by a particular payment brand or payment protocol. See the IOTP
payment method supplement for a description of how and when it used.
<!ELEMENT BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ContentSoftwareId See section 6.7.1 Brand Selection Brand Info
Element.
Content:
PackagedContent Packaged Content elements (see section 3.8) that
may contain additional data that may be required
by a particular payment brand. See the payment
method supplement for IOTP for rules on how this
is used.
6.7.3 Brand Selection Currency Amount Info Element
The Brand Selection Currency Amount Info Element contains any
additional data that is payment brand and currency specific that may
be required by a particular payment brand. See the IOTP payment method
supplement for a description of how and when it used.
David Burdett et al. [Page 138]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ContentSoftwareId See section 6.7.1 Brand Selection Brand Info
Element.
Content:
PackagedContent Packaged Content elements (see section 3.8) that
contain additional data relating to the payment
brand and currency. See the payment method
supplement for IOTP for rules on how this is
used.
6.8 Payment Component
A Payment Component contains information used to control how a payment
is carried out. Its provides information on:
o the times within which a Payment with a Payment Handler may be
started
o a reference to the Brand List (see section 6.6) which
identifies the Brands, protocols, currencies and amounts which
can be used to make a payment
o whether or not a payment receipt will be provided
o whether another payment precedes this payment.
Its definition is as follows.
David Burdett et al. [Page 139]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT Payment EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST Payment
ID ID #REQUIRED
OkFrom CDATA #REQUIRED
OkTo CDATA #REQUIRED
BrandListRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
SignedPayReceipt (True | False) #REQUIRED
StartAfter NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Payment Component within the IOTP Transaction.
OkFrom The date and time in [UTC] format after which a
Payment Handler may accept for processing a
Payment Request Block (see section 7.7)
containing the Payment Component.
OkTo The date and time in [UTC] format before which a
Payment Handler may for processing accept a
Payment Request Block containing the Payment
Component.
BrandListRef An Element Reference (see section 3.5) of a
Brand List Component (see section 6.6) within
the TPO Trading Block for the IOTP Transaction.
The Brand List identifies the alternative ways
in which the payment can be made.
SignedPayReceipt Indicates whether or not the Payment Response
Block (7.9) generated by the payment handler for
the payment must be digitally signed.
StartAfter Contains Element References (see section 3.5) of
other Payment Components which describe payments
which must be complete before this payment can
start. If no StartAfter attribute is present
then there are no dependencies and the payment
can start immediately
David Burdett et al. [Page 140]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.9 Payment Scheme Component
A Payment Scheme Component contains payment protocol information for a
specific payment scheme which is transferred between the parties
involved in a payment for example a [SET] message. Its definition is
as follows.
<!ELEMENT PaySchemeData (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST PaySchemeData
ID ID #REQUIRED
ConsumerPaymentId CDATA #IMPLIED
PaymentHandlerPayId CDATA #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Payment Scheme Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
ConsumerPaymentId An identifier specified by the Consumer which,
if returned by the Payment Handler in another
Payment Scheme Component or by other means,
will enable the Consumer to identify which
payment is being referred to.
PaymentHandlerPayId An identifier specified by the Payment Handler
which, if returned by the Consumer in another
Payment Scheme Component, or by other means,
will enable the Payment Handler to identify
which payment is being referred to. It is
required on every Payment Scheme Component
apart from the one contained in a Payment
Request Block.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by
xml:lang. It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
David Burdett et al. [Page 141]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the
SoftwareId attribute on the Message Id
Component (see section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Contains payment scheme protocol information as
Packaged Content elements (see section 3.8). See
the payment scheme supplement for the definition
of its content.
6.10 Payment Receipt Component
A Payment Receipt is a record of a payment which demonstrates how much
money has been paid or received. It is distinct from a purchase
receipt in that it contains no record of what was being purchased.
Typically the content of a Payment Receipt Component will contain data
which describes:
o the amount paid and its currency
o the date and time of the payment
o internal reference numbers which identify the payment to the
payment system
o potentially digital signatures generated by the payment method
which can be used to prove after the event that the payment
occurred.
If the Payment Method being used provides the facility then the
Payment Receipt Component should contain payment protocol messages, or
references to messages, which prove the payment occurred.
The precise definition of the content is Payment Method dependent.
Refer to the supplement for the payment method being used to determine
the rules that apply.
Information contained in the Payment Receipt Component should be
displayed or otherwise made available to the Consumer.
David Burdett et al. [Page 142]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[Note] If the Payment Receipt Component contains Payment Protocol
Messages, then the Messages will need to be processed by
Payment Method software to convert it into a format which
can be understood by the Consumer
[Note End]
The definition of a Payment Receipt Component is as follows.
<!ELEMENT PayReceipt (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST PayReceipt
ID ID #REQUIRED
PaymentRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReceiptRefs NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Payment Receipt Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
PaymentRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
to the Payment Component (see section 6.8) to
which this payment receipt applies
PayReceiptRefs Optionally contains Element References to other
Components (potentially including Pay Scheme
Components) which together make up the receipt.
Note that:
o each payment scheme defines in its supplement
the elements which must be referenced.
o each of the components must be referenced by
Digests in the Payment Response signature
component, if one is being used.
The client software should save all the
components referenced so that the payment
receipt can be reconstructed when required.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
David Burdett et al. [Page 143]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Contains payment scheme specific record of the
payment which can be used for receipt purposes
as Packaged Content elements (see section 3.8).
Each payment scheme defines in its supplement
the structure of the content.
Note that either the PayReceiptRefs attribute, the PackagedContent
element, or both must be present.
6.11 Payment Note Component
The Payment Note Component contains additional, non payment related,
information which the Payment Handler wants to provide to the
Consumer. For example, if a withdrawal or deposit were being made then
it could contain information on the remaining balance on the account
after the transfer was complete. The information should duplicate
information contained within the Payment Receipt Component.
Information contained in the Payment Note Component should be
displayed or otherwise made available to the Consumer. For
interoperability, the Payment Note Component should support, as a
minimum, the content types of Plain/Text and HTML. Its definition is
as follows.
<!ELEMENT PaymentNote (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST PaymentNote
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
David Burdett et al. [Page 144]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Payment Receipt Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Contains additional, non payment related,
information which the Payment Handler wants to
provide to the Consumer as one or more Packaged
Content elements (see section 3.8).
6.12 Delivery Component
The Delivery Element contains information required to deliver goods or
services. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT Delivery (DeliveryData?, PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST Delivery
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivExch (True | False) #REQUIRED
DelivAndPayResp (True | False) #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ConsumerDeliveryId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
David Burdett et al. [Page 145]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Delivery Component within the IOTP Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
DelivExch Indicates if this IOTP Transaction includes the
messages associated with a Delivery Exchange.
Valid values are:
. True indicates it does include a Delivery
Exchange
. False indicates it does not include a Delivery
Exchange
If set to true then a DeliveryData element must
be present. If set to false it may be absent.
DelivAndPayResp Indicates if the Delivery Response Block (see
section 7.11) and the Payment Response Block
(see section 7.9 ) are combined into one IOTP
Message. Valid values are:
o True indicates both blocks will be in the same
IOTP Message, and
o False indicates each block will be in a
different IOTP Message
DelivAndPayResp should not be true if DelivExch
is False.
In practice combining the Delivery Response
Block and Payment Response Block is only likely
to be practical if the Merchant, the Payment
Handler and the Delivery Handler are the same
organisation since:
o the Payment Handler must have access to Order
Component information so that they know what
to deliver, and
o the Payment Handler must be able to carry out
the delivery
ActionOrgRef An Element Reference to the Organisation
Component of the Delivery Handler for this
delivery.
David Burdett et al. [Page 146]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ConsumerDeliveryId An identifier specified by the Consumer which,
if returned by the Delivery Handler in another
Delivery Component, or by other means, will
enable the Consumer to identify which Delivery
is being referred to.
Content:
DeliveryData Contains details about how the delivery will be
carried out. See 6.12.1 Delivery Data Element
below.
PackagedContent Contains "user" data defined for the Merchant
which is required by the Delivery Handler as one
or more Packaged Content Elements see section
3.8.
6.12.1 Delivery Data Element
The DeliveryData element contains information about where and how
goods are to be delivered. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT DeliveryData (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryData
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
OkFrom CDATA #REQUIRED
OkTo CDATA #REQUIRED
DelivMethod NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivToRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivReqNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
SecDelivReqNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within
this component. See section 3.9 Identifying
Languages.
OkFrom The date and time in [UTC] format after which
the Delivery Handler may accept for processing a
Delivery Request Block (see section 7.10).
OkTo The date and time in [UTC] format before which
the Delivery Handler may accept for processing a
David Burdett et al. [Page 147]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Delivery Request Block.
DelivMethod Indicates the method by which goods or services
may be delivered. Valid values are:
o Post the goods will be delivered by post or
courier
o Web the goods will be delivered electronically
in the Delivery Note Component
o Email the goods will be delivered
electronically by e-mail
Values of DelivMethod are managed under the
procedure described in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes which allows user defined codes to be
defined.
DelivToRef The Element Reference (see section 3.4) of an
Organisation Component within the IOTP
Transaction which has a role of DelivTo. The
information in this block is used to determine
where delivery is to be made. It must be
compatible with DelivMethod. Specifically if the
DelivMethod is:
o Post, then the there must be a Postal Address
Element containing sufficient information for
a postal delivery,
o Web, then there are no specific requirements.
The information will be sent in a web page
back to the Consumer
o Email, then there must be Contact Information
Element with a valid e-mail address
DelivReqNetLocn This contains the Net Location to which an
unsecured Delivery Request Block (see section
7.10) which contains the Delivery Component
should be sent.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism must conform to
[RFC1738].
SecDelivReqNetLocn This contains the Net Location to which a
secured Delivery Request Block (see section
7.10) which contains the Delivery Component
should be sent.
A secured delivery request involves the use of a
David Burdett et al. [Page 148]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
secure channel such as [SSL] in order to
communicate with the Payment Handler.
The content of this attribute is dependent on
the Transport Mechanism must conform to
[RFC1738].
See also Section 3.10 Secure and Insecure Net
Locations.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the SoftwareId
attribute on the Message Id Component (see
section 3.3.2)
Content:
PackagedContent Additional information about the delivery as one
or more Packaged Content elements (see section
3.8) provided to the Delivery Handler by the
merchant.
6.13 Delivery Note Component
A Delivery Note contains delivery instructions about the delivery of
goods or services or potentially the actual Delivery Information
itself. It is information which the person or organisation receiving
the Delivery Note can use when delivery occurs.
For interoperability, the Delivery Note Component Packaged Content
should support both Plain Text and HTML.
David Burdett et al. [Page 149]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT DeliveryNote (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryNote
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivHandlerDelivId CDATA #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Delivery Note Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or
child elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
DelivHandlerDelivId An optional identifier specified by the
Delivery Handler which, if returned by the
Consumer in another Delivery Component, or by
other means, will enable the Delivery Handler
to identify which Delivery is being referred
to. It is required on every Delivery Component
apart from the one contained in a Delivery
Request Block.
An example use of this attribute is to contain
a delivery tracking number.
ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the
software which generated the content of the
element. Its purpose is to help resolve
interoperability problems that might occur as a
result of incompatibilities between messages
produced by different software. It is a single
text string in the language defined by
xml:lang. It must contain, as a minimum:
o the name of the software manufacturer
o the name of the software
o the version of the software, and
o the build of the software
It is recommended that this attribute is
included if the software which generated the
content cannot be identified from the
David Burdett et al. [Page 150]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
SoftwareId attribute on the Message Id
Component (see section 3.3.2)
Content:
DeliveryNote Contains actual delivery note information as one
or more Packaged Content elements (see section
3.8).
[Note] If the content of the Delivery Message is a Mime message
then the Delivery Note may trigger an application which
causes the actual delivery to occur.
[Note End]
6.14 Status Component
A Status Component contains status information about the business
success or failure (see section 4.2) of a process.
Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT Status EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST Status
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
StatusType NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProcessState (NotYetStarted | InProgress |
CompletedOk | Failed | ProcessError) #REQUIRED
CompletionCode NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference CDATA #IMPLIED
StatusDesc CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Status Component within the IOTP Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within
this component. See section 3.9 Identifying
Languages.
StatusType Indicates the type of process which the Status
is reporting on. It may be set to either Offer,
Payment, Delivery or Authentication.
David Burdett et al. [Page 151]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Values of StatusType are managed under the
procedure described in section 3.7.3 Values for
IOTP Codes which also allows user defined values
of StatusType to be defined.
ElRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
to the Component for which the Status is being
described. It must refer to either:
o a Trading Protocol Options Block (see section
7.1), if the StatusType is Offer,
o a Payment Component (see section 6.8), if the
StatusType is Payment, or
o a Delivery Component (see section 6.12), if
the StatusType is Delivery
o an Authentication Data Component (see section
6.2) if the StatusType is Authentication.
ProcessState Contains a State Code which indicates the
current state of the process being carried out.
Valid values for ProcessState are:
o NotYetStarted. A Request Block has been
received but the process has not yet started
o InProgress. Processing of the Request Block
has started but it is not yet complete
o CompletedOk. The processing of the Request
Block has completed successfully without any
errors
o Failed. The processing of the Request Block
has failed because of a business error (see
section 4.2)
o ProcessError. This value is only used when the
Status Component is being used in connection
with an Inquiry Request Trading Block (see
section 7.12). It indicates there was a
Technical Error (see section 4.1) in the
Request Block which is being processed or some
internal processing error.
Note that this code reports on the processing of
a Request Block. Further, asynchronous
processing may occur after the Response Block
associated with the Process has been sent.
CompletionCode Indicates how the process completed. Valid
values for the CompletionCode are given below
together with the conditions when it must be
David Burdett et al. [Page 152]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
present.
A CompletionCode is a maximum of 14 characters
long.
ProcessReference This optional attribute holds a reference for
the process whose status is being reported. It
may hold the following values:
o when StatusType is set to Offer, it should
contain the OrderIdentifier from the Order
Component
o when StatusType is set to Payment, it should
contain the PaymentHandlerPayId from the
Payment Scheme Data Component
o when StatusType is set to Delivery, it should
contain the DelivHandlerDelivId from the
Delivery Note Component
o when StatusType is set to Authentication, it
should contain the AuthenticationId from the
Authentication Data Component
This attribute should be absent in the Inquiry
Request message when the Consumer has not been
given such a reference number by the IOTP
Service Provider.
This attribute can be used in an Inquiry
Response Block (see section 7.13) to give the
reference number for a transaction which has
previously been unavailable.
For example, the package tracking number might
not be assigned at the time a delivery response
was received. However, if the Consumer issues a
Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry later, the
Delivery Handler can put the package tracking
number into this attribute in the Inquiry
Response message and send it back to the
Consumer.
StatusDesc An optional textual description of the current
status of the process in the language identified
by xml:lang.
David Burdett et al. [Page 153]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.14.1 Offer Completion Codes
The Completion Code is only required if the ProcessState attribute is
set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the
CompletionCode that may be used. It is recommended that the StatusDesc
attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.
Value Description
AuthError Authentication Error. The check of the
Authentication Response which was carried out
has failed.
ConsCancelled Consumer Cancelled. The Consumer decides to
cancel the transaction for some reason. This
code is only valid in a Status Component
contained in a Cancel Block.
MerchCancelled Offer Cancelled. The Merchant declines to
generate an offer for some reason and cancels
the transaction. This code is only valid in a
Status Component contained in a Cancel Block.
Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem
or error which does not fall into one of the
other CompletionCodes.
6.14.2 Payment Completion Codes
The CompletionCode is only required if the ProcessState attribute is
set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the
CompletionCode that may be used. It is recommended that the StatusDesc
attribute is used by individual payment schemes to provide further
explanation where appropriate.
Value Description
BrandNotSupp Brand not supported. The payment brand is not
supported by the Payment Handler.
CurrNotSupp Currency not supported. The currency in which
the payment is to be made is not supported by
either the Payment Instrument or the Payment
Handler.
ConsCancelled Consumer Cancelled. The Consumer decides to
David Burdett et al. [Page 154]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
cancel the payment for some reason. This code is
only valid in a Status Component contained in a
Cancel Block.
PaymtCancelled Payment Cancelled. The Payment Handler declines
to complete the payment for some reason and
cancels the transaction. This code is only valid
in a Status Component contained in a Cancel
Block.
AuthError Authentication Error. The Payment Scheme
specific authentication check which was carried
out has failed.
InsuffFunds Insufficient funds. There are insufficient funds
available for the payment to be made.
InstBrandInvalid Payment Instrument not valid for Brand. A
Payment Instrument is being used which does not
correspond with the Brand selected. For example
a Visa credit card is being used when MasterCard
was selected as the Brand.
InstNotValid Payment instrument not valid for trade. The
Payment Instrument cannot be used for the
proposed type of trade, for some reason.
BadInstrument Bad instrument. There is a problem with the
Payment Instrument being used which means that
it is unable to be used for the payment.
Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem
or error which does not fall into one of the
other CompletionCodes. The StatusDesc attribute
should provide the explanation of the cause.
6.14.3 Delivery Completion Codes
The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode
attribute for a Delivery. It is recommended that the StatusDesc
attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.
Value Description
BackOrdered Back Ordered. The goods to be delivered are on
order but they have not yet been received.
David Burdett et al. [Page 155]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Shipping will be arranged when they are
received. This is only valid if ProcessState is
CompletedOk.
PermNotAvail Permanently Not Available. The goods are
permanently unavailable and cannot be re-
ordered. This is only valid if ProcessState is
Failed.
TempNotAvail Temporarily Not Available. The goods are
temporarily unavailable and may become available
if they can be ordered. This is only valid if
ProcessState is CompletedOk.
ShipPending Shipping Pending. The goods are available and
are scheduled for shipping but they have not yet
been shipped. This is only valid if ProcessState
is CompletedOk.
Shipped Goods Shipped. The goods have been shipped.
Confirmation of delivery is awaited. This is
only valid if ProcessState is CompletedOk.
ShippedNoConf Shipped - No Delivery Confirmation. The goods
have been shipped but it is not possible to
confirm delivery of the goods. This is only
valid if ProcessState is CompletedOk.
ConsCancelled Consumer Cancelled. The Consumer decides to
cancel the delivery for some reason. This code
is only valid in a Status Component contained in
a Cancel Block.
DelivCancelled Delivery Cancelled. The Delivery Handler
declines to complete the Delivery for some
reason and cancels the transaction. This code is
only valid in a Status Component contained in a
Cancel Block.
Confirmed Confirmed. All goods have been delivered and
confirmation of their delivery has been
received. This is only valid if ProcessState is
CompletedOk.
Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem
or error which does not fall into one of the
other CompletionCodes. The StatusDesc attribute
David Burdett et al. [Page 156]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
should provide the explanation of the cause.
6.14.4 Authentication Completion Codes
The Completion Code is only required if the ProcessState attribute is
set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the
CompletionCode that may be used. It is recommended that the StatusDesc
attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.
Value Description
AutEeCancel Authenticatee Cancel. The organisation being
authenticated declines to be authenticated for
some reason. This could be, for example because
the signature on an Authentication Request was
invalid or the Authenticator was not known or
acceptable to the Authenticatee.
AutOrCancel Authenticator Cancel. The organisation
requesting authentication declines to validate
the Authentication Response received for some
reason and cancels the transaction.
NoAuthData Authentication Data Not Available. The
Authenticatee does not have the data that must
be provided so that they may be successfully
authenticated. For example a password may have
been forgotten, the Authenticatee has not yet
become a member, or a smart card token is not
present.
AuthFailed Authentication Failed. The Authenticator checked
the Authentication Response but the
authentication failed for some reason. For
example a password may have been incorrect.
TradRolesIncon Trading Roles Inconsistent. The Trading Roles
contained within the TradingRoleList attribute
of the Authentication Data Component are
inconsistent with the Trading Role which the
Authenticatee is taking in the IOTP Transaction
or is able to take. Examples of inconsistencies
include:
o asking a PaymentHandler for DeliveryHandler
information
o asking a Consumer for Merchant information
David Burdett et al. [Page 157]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem
or error which does not fall into one of the
other CompletionCodes.
6.15 Trading Role Data Component
The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque data which is needs to
be communicated between the Trading Roles involved in an IOTP
Transaction.
Trading Role Components identify:
o the organisation that generated the component, and
o the organisation that is to receive it.
They are first generated and included in a "Response" Block, and then
copied to the appropriate "Request" Block. For example a Payment
Handler might need to inform a Delivery Handler that a credit card
payment had been authorised but not captured. There may also be other
information that the Payment Handler has generated where the format is
privately agreed with the Delivery Handler which needs to be
communicated. In another example a Merchant might need to provide a
Payment Handler with some specific information about a Consumer so
that consumer can acquire double loyalty points with the payment.
Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT TradingRoleData (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST TradingRoleData
ID ID #REQUIRED
OriginatorElRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DestinationElRefs NMTOKENS #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Trading Role Data Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
OrginatorElRef Contains an element reference to the
Organisation Component of the Organisation that
created the Trading Role Data Component and
included it in a "Response" Block (e.g. an Offer
David Burdett et al. [Page 158]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Response or a Payment Response Block).
DestinationElRefs Contains element references to the Organisation
Components of the Organisations that are to
receive the Trading Role Data Component in a
"Request" Block (e.g. either a Payment Request
or a Delivery Request Block).
Content:
PackagedContent This contains the data which is to be sent
between the various Trading Roles as one or more
PackagedContent elements see section 3.8.
6.15.1 Who Receives a Trading Role Data Component
The rules for deciding what to do with Trading Role Data Components
are described below.
o whenever a Trading Role Data Component is received in a
"Response" block identify the Organisation Components of the
Organisations that are to receive it as identified by the
DestinationElRefs attribute.
o whenever a "Request" Block is being sent, check to see if it is
being sent to one of the Organisations identified by the
DestinationElRefs attribute. If it is then include in the
"Request" block:
- the Trading Role Data Component as well as,
- the Organisation Component of the Organisation identified by the
OriginatorElRef attribute (if not already present)
6.16 Inquiry Type Component
The Inquiry Component contains the information which indicates what
type of process is being inquired upon. Its definition is as follows.
David Burdett et al. [Page 159]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT InquiryType EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST InquiryType
ID ID #REQUIRED
Type NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Inquiry Type Component within the IOTP
Transaction.
Type Contains the type of inquiry. Valid values for
Type are:
o Offer. The inquiry is about the status of an
offer and is addressed to the Merchant.
o Payment. The inquiry is about the status of a
payment and is addressed to the Payment
Handler.
o Delivery. The inquiry is about the status of a
delivery and addressed to the Delivery
Handler.
ElRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
to the component to which this Inquiry Type
Component applies. That is,
o TPO Block when Type is Offer
o Payment Component when Type is Payment
o Delivery Component when Type is Delivery
ProcessReference Optionally contains a reference to the process
being inquired upon. It should be set if the
information is available. For the definition of
the values it may contain, see the
ProcessReference attribute of the Status
Component (see section 6.14).
6.17 Signature Component
[Note] Definitions of the XML structures for signatures and
certificates are described in the paper "Digital Signatures
for XML - Proposal", see [XMLDSIG]. As this is an Internet
Draft, it will be subject to revision.
David Burdett et al. [Page 160]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
However there is an immediate need for a more stable version
to be used with pilots of IOTP that are currently planned.
Therefore, this section contains a definition of a Signature
Component that closely follows the definitions contained in
XMLDSIG, but has been modified to meet some specific IOTP
requirements.
In the future it is anticipated that future versions of IOTP
will adopt a stable version of the XMLDSIG once it becomes
available.
[Note End]
Each Signature Component digitally signs one or more Blocks or
Components including other Signature Components.
The Signature Component:
o contains digests of one or more Blocks or Components in one or
more IOTP Messages within the same IOTP Transaction and places
the result in a Digest Element
o concatenates these Digest elements with other information on
the type of signature, the originator and potential recipients
of the signature and details of the signature algorithms being
used and places them in a Manifest element, and
o signs the Manifest element using the optional certificate
identified in the Certificate element within the Signature
Block placing the result in a Value element within a Signature
Component
Note that there may be multiple Value elements that contain signatures
of a Manifest Element.
A Signature Component can be one of four types either:
o an Offer Response Signature,
o a Payment Response Signature,
o a Delivery Response Signature, or
o an Authentication Response Signature.
For a general explanation of signatures see section 5 Security
Considerations.
David Burdett et al. [Page 161]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The definition of a Signature Component is as follows:
David Burdett et al. [Page 162]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT Signature (Manifest, Value+) >
<!ATTLIST Signature
ID ID #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT Manifest
(Algorithm+,
Digest+,
Attributes?,
OriginatorInfo,
RecipientInfo+,
)
<!ATTLIST Manifest
LocatorHRefBase CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT Algorithm (Parameter*) >
<!ATTRLIST Algorithm
ID ID #REQUIRED
type (digest|signature|keyagreement) #IMPLIED
name NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Digest (Value) >
<!ATTLIST Digest
LocatorHREF NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DigestAlgorithmRef IDREF #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Attributes (Attribute+) >
<!ELEMENT Attribute ( #PCDATA ) >
<!ATTLIST Attribute
type NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
critical ( true | false ) #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT OriginatorInfo ANY >
<!ATTLIST OriginatorInfo
OriginatorRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT RecipientInfo ANY >
<!ATTLIST RecipientInfo
SignatureAlgorithmRef IDREF #REQUIRED
SignatureValueRef IDREF #REQUIRED
SignatureCertRef IDREF #IMPLIED
RecipientRefs NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT Parameter ANY >
<!ATTLIST Parameter
type PCDATA #REQUIRED >
David Burdett et al. [Page 163]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.17.1 IOTP usage of signature elements and attributes
Detailed definitions of the above elements and attributes are
contained in [XMLDSIG]. The following contains additional information
that describes how these elements and attributes are used by IOTP.
SIGNATURE ELEMENT
The ID attribute is mandatory.
MANIFEST ELEMENT
The optional LocatorHrefBase attribute contains text which should be
concatenated before the text contained in the LocatorHREF attribute of
all Digest elements within the Manifest.
Its purpose is to reduce the size of LocatorHREF attribute values
since the first part of the LocatorHREF attributes in the same
signature are likely to be the same.
Typically, within IOTP, it will contain all the characters in a
LocatorHref attribute up to the sharp ("#") character (see immediately
below).
ALGORITHM AND PARAMETER ELEMENTS
The algorithm element identifies the algorithms used in generating the
signature. The type of the algorithm is defined by the value of the
Type attribute which indicates if it is the algorithm is to be used as
a Digest algorithm, a Signature algorithm or a Key Agreement
algorithm.
The following Digest algorithms must be implemented:
o a [DOM-HASH] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name
attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:ibm:dom-hash"
o a [SHA1] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name
attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:fips:sha1", and
o a [MD5] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name
attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:rsa:md5"
The following Signature algorithms must be implemented:
o a [DSA] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name
attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:us.gov:dsa"
David Burdett et al. [Page 164]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a [HMAC] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name
attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:ibm:hmac"
It is recommended that the following Signature algorithm is also
implemented:
o a [RSA] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name
attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:rsa:rsa"
In addition other payment scheme specific algorithms may be used. In
this case the value of the name attribute to use is specified in the
payment scheme supplement for that algorithm.
One algorithm may make use of other algorithms by use of the Parameter
element, for example:
<Algorithm ID=A1 type="digest" name="urn:ibm:dom-hash">
<Parameter type='AlgorithmRef'>A2</Parameter>
</Algorithm>
<Algorithm ID=A2 type="digest" name="urn:fips:sha1">
</Algorithm>
<Algorithm ID=A3 type="signature" name="urn:ibm:hmac">
<Parameter type='AlgorithmRef'>A1</Parameter>
</Algorithm>
DIGEST ELEMENT
The LocatorHREF attribute identifies the IOTP element which is being
digitally signed. Specifically it consists of:
o the value of the OtpTransId attribute of the Transaction ID
Component, followed by:
o a sharp character, i.e. "#", followed by
o an Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the element within
the IOTP Transaction which is the subject of the digest.
Before analysing the structure of the LocatorHREF attribute, it must
be concatenated with the value of the LocatorHrefBase attribute of the
Manifest element (see immediately above).
David Burdett et al. [Page 165]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ATTRIBUTE ELEMENT
There must be one and only one Attribute Element that contains a Type
attribute with a value of IOTPSignatureType and with content set to
either: OfferResponse, PaymentResponse, DeliveryResponse,
AuthenticationRequest, AuthenticationResponse, PingRequest or
PingResponse; depending on the type of the signature.
Values of the content of the Attribute element are controlled under
the procedures defined in section 3.7.3 Values for IOTP Codes which
also allows user defined values to be defined.
The Critical attribute must be set to true.
ORIGINATORINFO ELEMENT
The OriginatorRef attribute of the OriginatorInfo element must always
be present and contain an Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the
Organisation Component of the Organisation that generated the
Signature Component.
RECIPIENTINFO ELEMENT
The RecipientRefs attribute contains a list of Element References (see
section 3.5), that point to the Organisations that might need to
validate the signature. For details see below.
6.17.2 Offer Response Signature Component
The Manifest Element of a signature which has a type of OfferResponse
should contain Digest elements for the following Components:
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP
message that contains the Offer Response Signature
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP
Message that contains the Offer Response Signature
o from the TPO Block:
- the Protocol Options Component
- each of the Organisation Components
- each of the Brand List Components
o optionally, all the Brand Selection Components if they were
sent to the Merchant in a TPO Selection Block
David Burdett et al. [Page 166]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o from the Offer Response Block:
- the Order Component
- each of the Payment Components
- the Delivery Component
- each of the Authentication Data Components
- any Trading Role Data Components
The Offer Response Signature should also contain Digest elements for
the components that describe each of the organisations that may or
will need to verify the signature. This involves:
o if the Merchant has received a TPO Selection Block containing
Brand Selection Components, then generate a Digest element for
the Payment Handler identified by the Brand Selection Component
and the Delivery Handler identified by the Delivery Component.
See section 5.3.1 Check the Action Request was sent to the
Correct Organisation for a description of how this can be done.
o if the Merchant is not expecting to receive a TPO Selection
Block then generate a Digest element for the Delivery Handler
and all the Payment Handlers that are involved.
6.17.3 Payment Receipt Signature Component
The Manifest Element of the Payment Receipt Signature Component should
contain Digest Elements for the following Components:
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP
message that contains the Payment Receipt Signature
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP
Message that contains the Payment Receipt Signature
o the Offer Response Signature Component
o the Payment Receipt Component
o the Status Component
o the Brand Selection Component.
o any Trading Role Data Components
David Burdett et al. [Page 167]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.17.4 Delivery Response Signature Component
The Manifest Element of the Delivery Response Signature Component
should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP
message that contains the Delivery Response Signature
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP
Message that contains the Delivery Response Signature
o the Signature Components contained in the preceding Delivery
Request (if any)
o the Status Component
o the Delivery Note Component
6.17.5 Authentication Request Signature Component
The Manifest Element of the Authentication Request Signature Component
should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message that contains information that describes the IOTP
Message and IOTP Transaction
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally
uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction
o the following components of the TPO Block :
- the Protocol Options Component
- the Organisation Component
o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:
- the Authentication Data Component
6.17.6 Authentication Response Signature Component
The Manifest Element of the Authentication Response Signature
Component should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:
David Burdett et al. [Page 168]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message that contains information that describes the IOTP
Message and IOTP Transaction
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally
uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction
o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:
- the Authentication Data Component
o the Organisation Components contained in the Authentication
Response Block
6.17.7 Ping Request Signature Component
If the Ping Request is being singed (see section 8.2.2), the Manifest
Element of the Ping Request Signature Component should contain Digest
elements for all the Organisation Components.
6.17.8 Ping Response Signature Component
If the Ping Response is being singed (see section 8.2.2), the Manifest
Element of the Ping Response Signature Component should contain Digest
elements fir all the Organisation Components.
6.18 Certificate Component
[Note] Definitions of the XML structures for signatures and
certificates are described in the paper "Digital Signatures
for XML - Proposal", see [XMLDSIG]. As this is an Internet
Draft, it will be subject to revision.
See note at the start of section 6.17 Signature Component
for more details.
[Note End]
A Certificate Component contains a Digital Certificate. Its structure
is as follows:
David Burdett et al. [Page 169]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT Certificate (
IssuerAndSerialNumber
( Value | Locator ) )>
<!ATTLIST Certificate
ID ID #IMPLIED
type NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT IssuerAndSerialNumber EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST IssuerAndSerialNumber
issuer CDATA #REQUIRED
number CDATA #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Value ( #PCDATA ) >
<!ATTLIST Value
id ID #IMPLIED
encoding ( base64 | none ) #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Locator EMPTY>
<!ATTLIST Locator
href CDATA #REQUIRED >
6.18.1 IOTP usage of signature elements and attributes
Detailed definitions of the above elements and attributes are
contained in [XMLDSIG]. The following contains additional information
that describes how these elements and attributes are used by IOTP.
CERTIFICATE COMPONENT
The ID attribute is mandatory.
VALUE ELEMENT
The ID attribute is mandatory.
6.19 Error Component
The Error Component contains information about Technical Errors (see
section 4.1) in an IOTP Message which has been received by one of the
Trading Roles involved in the trade.
For clarity two phrases are defined which are used in the description
of an Error Component:
David Burdett et al. [Page 170]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o message in error. An IOTP message which contains or causes an
error of some kind
o message reporting the error. An IOTP message that contains an
Error Component that describes the error found in a message in
error.
The definition of the Error Component is as follows.
<!ELEMENT ErrorComp (ErrorLocation+, PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST ErrorComp
ID NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorCode NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
Severity (Warning|TransientError|HardError) #REQUIRED
MinRetrySecs CDATA #IMPLIED
SwVendorErrorRef CDATA #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Error Component within the IOTP Transaction.
xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child
elements within this component, unless
overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
element. See section 3.9 Identifying Languages.
ErrorCode Contains an error code which indicates the
nature of the error in the message in error.
Valid values for the ErrorCode are given in
section 6.19.2 Error Codes.
ErrorDesc Contains a narrative description of the error in
the language defined by xml:lang. The content of
this attribute is defined by the
vendor/developer of the software which generated
the Error Component
Severity Indicates the severity of the error. Valid
values are:
o Warning. This indicates that although there is
a message in error the IOTP Transaction can
still continue.
o TransientError. This indicates that the error
in the message in error may be recovered if
David Burdett et al. [Page 171]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
the message in error that is referred to by
the ErrorLocation element is resent
o HardError. This indicates that there is an
unrecoverable error in the message in error
and the IOTP Transaction must stop.
MinRetrySecs This attribute should be present if Severity is
set to TransientError. It is the minimum number
of whole seconds which the IOTP aware
application which received the message reporting
the error should wait before re-sending the
message in error identified by the ErrorLocation
element.
If Severity is not set to TransientError then
the value of this attribute is ignored.
SwVendorErrorRef This attribute is a reference whose value is set
by the vendor/developer of the software which
generated the Error Component. It should contain
data which enables the vendor to identify the
precise location in their software and the set
of circumstances which caused the software to
generate a message reporting the error. See also
the SoftwareId attribute of the Message Id
element in the Transaction Reference Block
(section 3.3).
Content:
ErrorLocation This identifies the IOTP Transaction Id of the
message in error and, where possible, the
element and attribute in the message in error
that caused the Error Component to be generated.
If the Severity of the error is not
TransientError, more than one ErrorLocation may
be specified as appropriate depending on the
nature of the error (see section 6.19.2 Error
Codes) and at the discretion of the
vendor/developer of the IOTP Aware Application.
PackagedContent This contains additional data which can be used
to understand the error. Its content may vary as
appropriate depending on the nature of the error
(see section 6.19.2 Error Codes) and at the
discretion of the vendor/developer of the IOTP
David Burdett et al. [Page 172]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Aware Application. For a definition of
PackagedContent see section 3.8.
6.19.1 Error Processing Guidelines
If there is more than one Error Component in a message reporting the
error, carry out the actions appropriate for the Error Component with
the highest severity. In this context, HardError has a higher severity
than TransientError, which has a higher severity than Warning.
6.19.1.1 Severity - Warning
If an IOTP aware application is generating a message reporting the
error with an Error Component where the Severity attribute is set to
Warning, then if the message reporting the error does not contain
another Error Component with a severity higher than Warning, the IOTP
Message must also include the Trading Blocks and Trading Components
that would have been included if no error was being reported.
If a message reporting the error is received with an Error Component
where Severity is set to Warning, then:
o it is recommended that information about the error is either
logged, or otherwise reported to the user,
o the implementer of the IOTP aware application must either, at
their or the user's discretion:
- continue the IOTP transaction as normal, or
- fail the IOTP transaction by generating a message reporting the
error with an Error Component with Severity set to HardError (see
section 6.19.1.3).
If the intention is to continue the IOTP transaction then, if there
are no other Error Components with a higher severity, check that the
necessary Trading Blocks and Trading Components for normal processing
of the transaction to continue are present. If they are not then
generate a message reporting the error with an Error Component with
Severity set to HardError.
6.19.1.2 Severity - Transient Error
If an IOTP Aware Application is generating a message reporting the
error with an Error Component where the Severity attribute is set to
TransientError, then there should be only one Error Component in the
message reporting the error. In addition, the MinRetrySecs attribute
should be present.
David Burdett et al. [Page 173]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
If a message reporting the error is received with an Error Component
where Severity is set to TransientError then:
o if the MinRetrySecs attribute is present and a valid number,
then use the MinRetrySecs value given. Otherwise if
MinRetrySecs is missing or is invalid, then:
- generate a message reporting the error containing an Error
Component with a Severity of Warning and send it on the next IOTP
message (if any) to be sent to the Trading Role which sent the
message reporting the error with the invalid MinRetrySecs, and
- use a value for MinRetrySecs which is set by the vendor/developer
of the IOTP Aware Application.
o check that only one ErrorLocation element is contained within
the Error Component and that it refers to an IOTP Message which
was sent by the recipient of the Error Component with a
Severity of TransientError. If more than one ErrorLocation is
present then generate a message reporting the error with a
Severity of HardError.
6.19.1.3 Severity - Hard Error
If an IOTP Aware Application is generating a message reporting the
error with an Error Component where the Severity attribute set to
HardError, then there should be only one Error Component in the
message reporting the error.
If a message reporting the error is received with an Error Component
where Severity is set to HardError then terminate the IOTP
Transaction.
6.19.2 Error Codes
The following table contains the valid values for the ErrorCode
attribute of the Error Component. The first sentence of the
description contains the text that should be used to describe the
error when displayed or otherwise reported. Individual implementations
may translate this into alternative languages at their discretion.
An Error Code must not be more that 14 characters long.
Value Description
Reserved Reserved. This error is reserved by the
vendor/developer of the software. Contact the
David Burdett et al. [Page 174]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Value Description
vendor/developer of the software for more
information See the SoftwareId attribute of the
Message Id element in the Transaction Reference
Block(section 3.3).
XmlNotWellFrmd XML not well formed. The XML document is not
well formed. See [XML] for the meaning of "well
formed". Even if the XML is not well formed, it
should still be scanned to find the Transaction
Reference Block so that a properly formed Error
Response may be generated.
XmlNotValid XML not valid. The XML document is well formed
but the document is not valid. See [XML] for the
meaning of "valid". Specifically:
o the XML document does not comply with the
constraints defined in the IOTP document type
declaration (see section 11 Open Trading
Protocol Data Type Definition), and
o the XML document does not comply with the
constraints defined in the document type
declaration of any additional [XML Namespace]
that are declared.
As for XML not well formed, attempts should
still be made to extract the Transaction
Reference Block so that a properly formed Error
Response may be generated.
ElUnexpected Unexpected element. Although the XML document is
well formed and valid, an element is present
that is not expected in the particular context
according to the rules and constraints contained
in this specification.
ElNotSupp Element not supported. Although the document is
well formed and valid, an element is present
that:
o is consistent with the rules and constraints
contained in this specification, but
o is not supported by the IOTP Aware Application
which is processing the IOTP Message.
ElMissing Element missing. Although the document is well
formed and valid, an element is missing that
David Burdett et al. [Page 175]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Value Description
should have been present if the rules and
constraints contained in this specification are
followed.
In this case set the PackagedContent of the
Error Component to the type of the missing
element.
ElContIllegal Element content illegal. Although the document
is well formed and valid, the element
PackagedContent contains values which do not
conform to the rules and constraints contained
in this specification.
EncapProtErr Encapsulated protocol error. Although the
document is well formed and valid, the
PackagedContent of an element contains data from
an encapsulated protocol which contains errors.
AttUnexpected Unexpected attribute. Although the XML document
is well formed and valid, the presence of the
attribute is not expected in the particular
context according to the rules and constraints
contained in this specification.
AttNotSupp Attribute not supported. Although the XML
document is well formed and valid, and the
presence of the attribute in an element is
consistent with the rules and constraints
contained in this specification, it is not
supported by the IOTP Aware Application which is
processing the IOTP Message.
AttMissing Attribute missing. Although the document is well
formed and valid, an attribute is missing that
should have been present if the rules and
constraints contained in this specification are
followed.
In this case set the PackagedContent of the
Error Component to the type of the missing
attribute.
AttValIllegal Attribute value illegal. The attribute contains
a value which does not conform to the rules and
David Burdett et al. [Page 176]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Value Description
constraints contained in this specification.
AttValNotRecog Attribute Value Not Recognised. The attribute
contains a value which the IOTP Aware
Application generating the message reporting the
error could not recognise even though it should
have been able to since the information had been
provided in an earlier IOTP message.
MsgTooLarge Message too large. The message is too large to
be processed by the IOTP Aware Application.
ElTooLarge Element too large. The element is too large to
be processed by the IOTP Aware Application
ValueTooSmall Value too small or early. The value of all or
part of the PackagedContent of an element or an
attribute, although valid, is too small.
ValueTooLarge Value too large or in the future. The value of
all or part of the PackagedContent of an
element or an attribute, although valid, is too
large.
ElInconsistent Element Inconsistent. Although the document is
well formed and valid, according to the rules
and constraints contained in this specification:
o the content of an element is inconsistent with
the content of other elements or their
attributes, or
o the value of an attribute is inconsistent with
the value of one or more other attributes.
In this case create ErrorLocation elements which
identify all the attributes or elements which
are inconsistent.
TransportError Transport Error. This error code is used to
indicate that there is a problem with the
Transport Mechanism which is preventing the
message from being received. It is typically
associated with a Transient Error. Explanation
of the Transport Error is contained within the
ErrorDesc attribute. The values which can be
used inside ErrorDesc with a TransportError is
David Burdett et al. [Page 177]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Value Description
specified in the IOTP supplement for the
Transport mechanism.
UnknownError Unknown Error. Indicates that the transaction
cannot complete for some reason that is not
covered explicitly by any of the other errors.
The ErrorDesc attribute should be used to
indicate the nature of the problem.
This could be used to indicate, for example, an
internal error in a backend server or client
process of some kind.
6.19.3 Error Location Element
An Error Location Element identifies an element and optionally an
attribute in the message in error which is associated with the error.
It contains a reference to the IOTP Message, Trading Block, Trading
Component, element and attribute, which is in error.
<!ELEMENT ErrorLocation EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST ErrorLocation
ElementType NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OtpMsgRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BlkRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
CompRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ElementRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AttName NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ElementType This is the "type" (see [XML]) of the Element in
the message in error where the error is located.
OtpMsgRef This is the value of the ID attribute of the of
the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2) of
the message in error to which this Error
Component applies.
BlkRef If the error is associated with a specific
Trading Block, then this is the value of the ID
attribute of the Trading Block where the error
is located.
David Burdett et al. [Page 178]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
CompRef If the error is associated with a specific
Trading Component, then this is the value of the
ID attribute of the Trading Component where the
error is located.
ElementRef If the error is associated with a specific
element within a Trading Component then, if the
element has an attribute with an "attribute
type" (see [XML]) of "ID", then this is the
value of that attribute.
AttName If the error is associated with the value of an
attribute, then this is the name of that
attribute. In this case the PackagedContent of
the Error Component should contain the value of
the attribute.
Note that as many as the attributes as possible should be included.
For example if an attribute in a child element of a Trading Component
contains an incorrect value, then all the attributes of ErrorLocation
should be present.
David Burdett et al. [Page 179]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
7. Trading Blocks
Trading Blocks consist of one or more Trading Components and
optionally one or more Signature Components. One or more Trading
Blocks may be contained within the IOTP Messages which are physically
sent in the form of [XML] documents between the different
organisations that are taking part in a trade.
This is illustrated in the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 180]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
IOTP MESSAGE <----------- IOTP Message - an XML Document
| which is transported between the
| Trading Roles
|-Trans Ref Block <----- Trans Ref Block - contains
| | information which describes the
| | IOTP Transaction and the IOTP
| | Message.
| |-Trans Id Comp. <--- Transaction Id Component -
| | uniquely identifies the IOTP
| | Transaction. The Trans Id
| | Components are the same across
| | all IOTP messages that comprise a
| | single IOTP transaction.
| |-Msg Id Comp. <----- Message Id Component - identifies
| and describes an IOTP Message
| within an IOTP Transaction
|-Signature Block <----- Signature Block (optional) -
| | contains one or more Signature
| | Components and their associated
| | Certificates
| |-Signature Comp. <-- Signature Component - contains
| | digital signatures. Signatures
| | may sign digests of the Trans Ref
| | Block and any Trading Component
| | in any IOTP Message in the same
| | IOTP Transaction.
| |-Certificate Comp. <- Certificate Component. Used to
| check the signature.
------> |-Trading Block <-------- Trading Block - an XML Element
| | |-Component within an IOTP Message that
Trading | |-Component contains a predefined set of
Blocks | |-Component Trading Components
| | |-Component
| | |-Component <--------- Trading Components - XML Elements
| | within a Trading Block that
------> |-Trading Block contain a predefined set of XML
| |-Component elements and attributes
| |-Component containing information required
| |-Component to support a Trading Exchange
| |-Component
| |-Component
|
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 18 Trading Blocks
David Burdett et al. [Page 181]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Trading Blocks are defined as part of the definition of an IOTP
Message (see section 3.1.1). The definition of an IOTP Message element
is repeated here:
<!ELEMENT OtpMessage
( TransRefBlk,
SigBlk?,
ErrorBlk?,
( AuthReqBlk |
AuthRespBlk |
AuthStatusBlk |
CancelBlk |
DeliveryReqBlk |
DeliveryRespBlk |
InquiryReqBlk |
InquiryRespBlk |
OfferRespBlk |
PayExchBlk |
PayReqBlk |
PayRespBlk |
PingReqBlk |
PingRespBlk |
TpoBlk |
TpoSelectionBlk
)*
) >
The remainder of this section defines the Trading Blocks in this
version of IOTP. They are:
o Authentication Request Block
o Authentication Response Block
o Authentication Status Block
o Cancel Block
o Delivery Request Block
o Delivery Response Block
o Error Block
o Inquiry Request Block
o Inquiry Response Block
David Burdett et al. [Page 182]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Offer Response Block
o Payment Exchange Block
o Payment Request Block
o Payment Response Block
o Signature Block
o Trading Protocol Options Block
o TPO Selection Block
The Transaction Reference Block is described in section 3.3.
7.1 Trading Protocol Options Block
The TPO Trading Block contains options which apply to the IOTP
Transaction. The definition of a TPO Trading Block is as follows.
<!ELEMENT TpoBlk ( ProtocolOptions, BrandList*, Org* ) >
<!ATTLIST TpoBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Trading Protocol Options Block within the IOTP
Transaction (see section 3.4 ID Attributes).
Content:
ProtocolOptions The Protocol Options Component (see section
6.1)defines the options which apply to the whole
IOTP Transaction (see section 8).
BrandList This Brand List Component contains one or more
payment brands and protocols which may be
selected (see section 6.6).
Org The Organisation Components (see section 6.5)
identify the organisations and their roles in
the IOTP Transaction. The roles and
organisations which must be present will depend
David Burdett et al. [Page 183]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
on the particular type of IOTP Transaction. See
the definition of each transaction in section 8.
Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions.
The TPO Block should contain:
o the Protocol Options Component
o the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of Merchant
o the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of Consumer
o optionally, the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of
DeliverTo, if there is a Delivery included in the IOTP
Transaction
o Brand List Components for each payment in the IOTP Transaction
o Organisation Components for all the Payment Handlers involved
o optionally, Organisation Components for the Delivery Handler
(if any) for the transaction
o additional Organisation Components that the Merchant may want
to include. For example
- a Customer Care Provider
- an Certificate Authority that offers Merchant "Credentials" or
some other warranty on the goods or services being offered.
7.2 TPO Selection Block
The TPO Selection Block contains the results of selections made from
the options contained in the Trading Protocol Options Block (see
section 7.1).The definition of a TPO Selection Block is as follows.
<!ELEMENT TpoSelectionBlk (BrandSelection+) >
<!ATTLIST TpoSelectionBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the TPO
Selection Block within the IOTP Transaction.
Content:
David Burdett et al. [Page 184]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
BrandSelection This identifies the choice of payment brand and
payment protocol to be used in a payment within
the IOTP Transaction. There is one Brand
Selection Component (see section 6.7) for each
payment to be made in the IOTP Transaction.
The TPO Selection Block should contain one Brand Selection Component
for each Brand List in the TPO Block.
7.3 Offer Response Block
The Offer Response Block contains details of the goods, services,
amount, delivery instructions or financial transaction which is to
take place. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT OfferRespBlk (Status, Order?, Payment*,
Delivery?, TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST OfferRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Offer Response Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains status information about the business
success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
generation of the Offer. Note that in an Offer
Response Block, a ProcessState of NotYetStarted
or InProgress are illegal values.
Order The Order Component contains details about the
goods, services or financial transaction which
is taking place see section 6.4.
The Order Component must be present unless the
ProcessState attribute of the Status Component
is set to Failed.
Payment The Payment Components contain information about
the payments which are to be made see section
David Burdett et al. [Page 185]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
6.8.
Delivery The Delivery Component contains details of the
delivery to be made (see section 6.12).
TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque
data which is needs to be communicated between
the Trading Roles involved in an OTP Transaction
(see section 6.15).
The Offer Response Block should contain:
o the Order Component for the IOTP Transaction
o Payment Components for each Payment in the IOTP Transaction
o the Delivery Component the IOTP Transaction requires (if any).
7.4 Authentication Request Block
This Authentication Request Block contains the challenge data which is
used to obtain information about and optionally authenticate a
Consumer by another Trading Role. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT AuthReqBlk (AuthData?) >
<!ATTLIST AuthReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Authentication Request Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content
AuthData If the Authentication Data Component is not
present it means that the Authentication Request
Block is just requesting the return of
Organisation Components which describe the
Trading Role that received the Authentication
Request Block.
If the optional Authentication Data Component
(see section 6.2) is present it contains data
David Burdett et al. [Page 186]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
which describes the different types of
Authentication the consumer should provide.
7.5 Authentication Response Block
The Authentication Response Block contains the response which results
from processing the Authentication Request Block. Its definition is as
follows.
<!ELEMENT AuthRespBlk (AuthResp, Org*) >
<!ATTLIST AuthRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Authentication Response Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
AuthResp The Authentication Response Component which
contains the results of processing the challenge
data in the Authentication Data Component - see
section 6.3.
Org Organisation Components which contain
information corresponding to the Trading Roles
as requested by the TradingRoleList attribute of
the AuthData component.
7.6 Authentication Status Block
The Authentication Status Block indicates the success or failure of
the validation of an Authentication Response Block by an
Authenticator. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT AuthStatusBlk (Status) >
<!ATTLIST AuthStatusBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
David Burdett et al. [Page 187]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Authentication Status Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains status information about the business
success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
authentication
7.7 Payment Request Block
The Payment Request Block contains information which requests that a
payment is started. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT PayReqBlk (Status+, BrandList, BrandSelection,
Payment, PaySchemeData?, Org*, TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST PayReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Payment Request Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains the Status Components (see section
6.12) of the responses of the steps (e.g. an
Offer Response and/or a Payment Response) on
which this step depends. It is used to indicate
the success or failure of those steps. Payment
should only occur of the previous steps were
successful.
BrandList The Brand List Component contains a list of one
or more payment brands and protocols which may
be selected (see section 6.6).
BrandSelection This identifies the choice of payment brand, the
payment protocol and the payment handler to be
used in a payment within the IOTP Transaction.
There is one Brand Selection Component (see
David Burdett et al. [Page 188]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
section 6.7) for each payment to be made in the
IOTP Transaction.
Payment The Payment Components contain information about
the payment which is being made see section 6.8.
PaySchemeData The Payment Scheme Component contains payment
scheme specific data see section 6.9.
Org The Organisation Component contains details of
organisations involved in the payment (see
section 6.5). The Organisations present are
dependent on the IOTP Transaction and the data
which is to be signed. See section 5 Security
Considerations for more details.
TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque
data which is needs to be communicated between
the Trading Roles involved in an OTP Transaction
(see section 6.15).
The Payment Request Block should contain:
o the Organisation Component with a Trading Role of Merchant
o the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of Consumer
o the Payment Component for the Payment
o the Brand List Component for the Payment
o the Brand Selection Component for the Brand List
o the Organisation Component for the Payment Handler of the
Payment
o the Organisation Component (if any) for the Organisation which
carried out the previous step, for example another Payment
Handler
o the Organisation Component for the organisation which is to
carry out the next step, if any. This may be, for example,
either a Delivery Handler or a Payment Handler.
o the Organisation Components for any additional Organisations
that the Merchant has included in the Offer Response Block
David Burdett et al. [Page 189]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o an Optional Payment Scheme Data Component, if required by the
Payment Method as defined in the IOTP supplement for the
payment method
o any Trading Role Data Components that may be required (see
section 6.15.1).
7.8 Payment Exchange Block
The Payment Exchange Block contains payment scheme specific data which
is exchanged between two of the roles in a trade. Its definition is as
follows.
<!ELEMENT PayExchBlk (PaySchemeData) >
<!ATTLIST PayExchBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Payment Exchange Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
PaySchemeData This Trading Component contains payment scheme
specific data see section 6.9 Payment Scheme
Component.
7.9 Payment Response Block
This Payment Response Block contains a information about the Payment
Status, a Payment Receipt, and an optional payment protocol message.
Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT PayRespBlk (Status, PayReceipt, PaySchemeData?,
PaymentNote?, TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST PayRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
David Burdett et al. [Page 190]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Payment Response Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains status information about the business
success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
payment. Note that in a Pay Response Block, a
ProcessState of NotYetStarted or InProgress are
illegal values.
PayReceipt Contains payment scheme specific data which can
be used to verify the payment occurred. See
section 6.10 Payment Receipt Component.
PaySchemeData Contains payment scheme specific data see
section, for example a payment protocol message.
See 6.9 Payment Scheme Component.
PaymentNote Contains additional, non payment related,
information which the Payment Handler wants to
provide to the Consumer. For example, if a
withdrawal or deposit were being made then it
could contain information on the remaining
balance on the account after the transfer was
complete. See section 6.11 Payment Note
Component.
TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque
data which is needs to be communicated between
the Trading Roles involved in an OTP Transaction
(see section 6.15).
7.10 Delivery Request Block
The Delivery Request Block contains details of the goods or services
which are to be delivered together with a signature which can be used
to check that delivery is authorised. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT DeliveryReqBlk (Status+, Order, Org*, Delivery,
TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
David Burdett et al. [Page 191]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Delivery Request Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains the Status Components (see section
6.12) of the responses of the steps (e.g. a
Payment Response) on which this step is
dependent. It is used to indicate the success or
failure of those steps. Delivery should only
occur of the previous steps were successful.
Order The Order Component contains details about the
goods, services or financial transaction which
is taking place see section 6.4.
Org The Organisation Components (see section 6.5)
identify the organisations and their roles in
the IOTP Transaction. The roles and
organisations which must be present will depend
on the particular type of IOTP Transaction. See
the definition of each transaction in section 8.
Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions.
Delivery The Delivery Component contains details of the
delivery to be made (see section 6.12).
TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque
data which is needs to be communicated between
the Trading Roles involved in an OTP Transaction
(see section 6.15).
The Delivery Request Block contains:
o the Organisation Component with a Trading Role of Merchant
o the Organisation Component for the Consumer and DeliverTo
Trading Roles
o the Delivery Component for the Delivery
o the Organisation Component for the Delivery Handler.
Specifically the Organisation Component identified by the
ActionOrgRef attribute on the Delivery Component
David Burdett et al. [Page 192]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the Organisation Component (if any) for the Organisation which
carried out the previous step, for example a Payment Handler
o the Organisation Components for any additional Organisations
that the Merchant has included in the Offer Response Block
o any Trading Role Data Components that may be required (see
section 6.15.1).
7.11 Delivery Response Block
The Delivery Response Block contains a Delivery Note containing
details on how the goods will be delivered. Its definition is as
follows. Note that in a Delivery Response Block a Delivery Status
Element with a DeliveryStatusCode of NotYetStarted or InProgress is
invalid.
<!ELEMENT DeliveryRespBlk (Status, DeliveryNote) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Delivery Response Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains status information about the business
success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
delivery. Note that in a Delivery Response
Block, a ProcessState of NotYetStarted or
InProgress are illegal values.
DeliveryNote The Delivery Note Component contains details
about how the goods or services will be
delivered (see section 6.13).
David Burdett et al. [Page 193]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
7.12 Inquiry Request Trading Block
The Inquiry Request Trading Block contains an Inquiry Type Component
and an optional Payment Scheme Component to contain payment scheme
specific inquiry messages.
<!ELEMENT InquiryReqBlk ( InquiryType, PaySchemeData? ) >
<!ATTLIST InquiryReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Inquiry Request Trading Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
InquiryType Inquiry Type Component (see section 6.16) that
contains the type of inquiry.
PaySchemeData Payment Scheme Component (see section 6.9) that
contains payment scheme specific inquiry
messages for inquiries on payments. This is
present when the Type attribute of Inquiry Type
Component is Payment.
7.13 Inquiry Response Trading Block
The Inquiry Response Trading Block contains a Status Component and an
optional Payment Scheme Component to contain payment scheme specific
inquiry messages. Its purpose is to enquire on the current status of
an IOTP transaction at a server.
<!ELEMENT InquiryRespBlk (Status, PaySchemeData?) >
<!ATTLIST InquiryRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED
LastReceivedOtpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
LastSentOtpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Inquiry Response Trading Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
David Burdett et al. [Page 194]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
LastReceivedOtpMsg Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
Ref to the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2)
of the last message this server has received
from the Consumer. If there is no previously
received message from the Consumer in the
pertinent transaction, this attribute should be
contain the value Null. This attribute exists
for debugging purposes.
LastSentOtpMsgRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)
to the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2)
of the last message this server has sent to the
Consumer. If there is no previously sent message
to the Consumer in the pertinent transaction,
this attribute should contain the value Null.
This attribute exists for debugging purposes.
Content:
Status Contains status information about the business
success (see section 4.2) or failure of a
certain trading exchange (i.e., Offer, Payment,
or Delivery).
PaySchemeData Payment Scheme Component (see section 6.9) that
contains payment scheme specific inquiry
messages for inquiries on payments. This is
present when the Type attribute of StatusType
attribute of the Status Component is set to
Payment.
7.14 Ping Request Block
The Ping Request Block is used to determine if a Server is operating
and whether or not cryptography is compatible.
The definition of a Ping Request Block is as follows.
<!ELEMENT PingReqBlk (Org*)>
<!ATTLIST PingReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED>
Attributes:
David Burdett et al. [Page 195]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Ping
Request Trading Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
Content:
Org Optional Organisation Components (see section
6.5).
If no Organisation Component is present then the
Ping Request is anonymous and simply determines
if the server is operating.
However if Organisation Components are present,
then it indicates that the sender of the Ping
Request wants to verify that digital signatures
can be handled.
In this case the sender includes:
o an Organisation Component that identifies
itself specifying the Trading Role(s) it is
taking in IOTP transactions (Merchant, Payment
Handler, etc)
o an Organisation Component that identifies the
intended recipient of the message.
These are then used to generate a signature over
the Ping Response Block.
7.15 Ping Response Block
The Ping Response Trading Block provides the result of a Ping Request.
It contains an Organisation Component that identifies the sender of
the Ping Response.
If the Ping Request to which this block is a response contained
Organisation Components, then it also contains those Organisation
Components.
David Burdett et al. [Page 196]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT PingRespBlk (Org+)>
<!ATTLIST PingRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED
PingStatusCode (Ok | Busy | Down) #REQUIRED
SigVerifyStatusCode (Ok | NotSupported | Fail) #IMPLIED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
PingStatusDesc CDATA #IMPLIED>
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Ping Request Trading Block within the IOTP
Transaction.
PingStatusCode Contains a code which shows the status of the
sender software which processes IOTP messages.
Valid values are:
o Ok. Everything with the service is working
normally, including the signature
verification.
o Busy. Things are working normally but there
may be some delays.
o Down. The server is not functioning fully but
can still provide a Ping response.
SigVerifyStatusCode Contains a code which shows the status of
signature verification. This is present only
when the message containing the Ping Request
Block also contains a Signature Block. Valid
values are:
o Ok. The signature has successfully been
verified and proved compatible.
o NotSupported The receiver of this Ping
Request Block does not support validation of
signatures.
o Fail. Signature verification failed.
Xml:lang Defines the language used in PingStatusDesc.
This is present when PingStatusDesc is present.
PingStatusDesc Contains a short description of the status of
the server which sends this Ping Response
Block. Servers, if their designers want, can
use this attribute to send more refined status
information than PingStatusCode which can be
used for debugging purposes, for example.
David Burdett et al. [Page 197]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Content:
Org These are Organisation Components (see section
6.5).
The Organisation Components of the sender of the
Ping Response is always included in addition to
the Organisation Components sent in the Ping
Request.
[Note] Ping Status Code values do not include a value such as Fail,
since, when the software receiving the Ping Request message
is not working at all, no Ping Response message will be sent
back.
[Note End]
7.16 Signature Block
The Signature Block contains one or more Signature Components and
associated Certificates which sign data associated with the IOTP
Transaction. For a general discussion and introduction to how IOTP
uses signatures, see section 5 Security Considerations. The definition
of the Signature Component and certificates is contained in the paper
"Digital Signature for XML - Proposal", see [XMLDSIG]. Descriptions of
how these are used by IOTP is contained in sections 6.17 and 6.18.
The definition of a Signature Block is as follows:
<!ELEMENT IOTPSignatures (Signature+, Certificate*) >
<!ATTLIST IOTPSignatures
ID ID #IMPLIED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Signature Block within the IOTP Transaction.
Content:
Signature A Signature Component. See section 6.17.
Certificate A Certificate Component. See section 6.18.
The contents of a Signature Block depends on the Trading Block that is
contained in the same IOTP Message as the Signature Block.
David Burdett et al. [Page 198]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
7.16.1 Offer Response
A Signature Block which is in the same message as an Offer Response
Block contains just an Offer Response Signature Component (see section
6.17.2).
7.16.2 Payment Request
A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Payment Request
Block contains:
o an Offer Response Signature Component (see section 6.17.2), and
o if the Payment is dependent on an earlier step (as indicated by
the StartAfter attribute on the Payment Component), then the
Payment Receipt Signature Component (see section 6.17.3)
generated by the previous step
7.16.3 Payment Response
A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Payment Response
Block contains just a Payment Receipt Signature Component (see section
6.17.3) generated by the step.
7.16.4 Delivery Request
A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Delivery Request
Block contains:
o an Offer Response Signature Component (see section 6.17.2), and
o the Payment Receipt Signature Component (see section 6.17.3)
generated by the previous step.
7.17 Error Block
The Error Trading Block contains one or more Error Components (see
section 6.19) which contain information about Technical Errors (see
section 4.1) in an IOTP Message which has been received by one of the
Trading Roles involved in the trade.
David Burdett et al. [Page 199]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
For clarity two phrases are defined which are used in the description
of an Error Trading Block:
o message in error. An IOTP message which contains or causes an
error of some kind
o message reporting the error. An IOTP message that contains an
Error Trading Block that describes the error found in a message
in error.
An Error Trading Block may be contained in any message reporting the
error. The action which then follows depends on the severity of the
error. See the definition of an Error Component, for an explanation of
the different types of severity and the actions which can then occur.
[Note] Although, an Error Trading Block can report multiple
different errors using multiple Error Components, there is
no obligation on a developer of an IOTP Aware Application to
do so.
[Note End]
The structure of an Error Trading Block is as follows.
<!ELEMENT ErrorBlk (ErrorComp+, PaySchemeData*) >
<!ATTLIST ErrorBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Error Trading Block within the IOTP Transaction.
Content:
ErrorComp An Error Components (see section 6.19) that
contains information about an individual
Technical Error.
PaySchemeData An optional Payment Scheme Component (see
section 6.9) which contains a Payment Scheme
Message. See the appropriate payment scheme
supplement to determine whether or not this
component needs to be present and for the
definition of what it must contain.
David Burdett et al. [Page 200]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
7.18 Cancel Block
The Cancel Block is used to inform a non-Consumer role such as a
Merchant, Payment Handler or Delivery Handler that a transaction has
been cancelled by the Consumer. It's main purpose is to allow the
server to close down the transaction without a waiting for a time-out
to occur. Its definition is as follows.
<!ELEMENT CancelBlk (Status) >
<!ATTLIST CancelBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
Attributes:
ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the
Cancel Block within the IOTP Transaction.
Content:
Status Contains status information indicating that the
IOTP transaction has been cancelled.
David Burdett et al. [Page 201]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
8. Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions
The Baseline Open Trading Protocol supports four types of transactions
for different purposes. These are
o an Authentication IOTP transaction which supports
authentication of one party in a trade by another
o IOTP Transactions that involve one or more payments.
Specifically:
- Deposit
- Purchase
- Refund
- Withdrawal, and
- Value Exchange
o IOTP Transactions designed to check the correct function of the
IOTP infrastructure. Specifically:
- Transaction Status Inquiry, and
- Ping
Although the Authentication IOTP Transaction can operate on its own,
authentication can optionally precede any of the _payment_
transactions. Therefore, the rest of this section is divided into two
parts covering:
o Authentication and Payment transactions (Authentication,
Deposit, Purchase, Refund, Withdrawal and Value Exchange)
o Infrastructure Transactions (Transaction Status Inquiry and
Ping) that are designed to support inquiries on whether or not
a transaction has succeeded or a Trading Role's servers are
operating correctly, and
8.1 Authentication and Payment Related IOTP Transactions
The Authentication and Payment related IOTP Transactions consist of
six Document Exchanges which are then combined in sequence to
implement a specific transaction.
Generally, there is a close, but not exact, correspondence between a
Document Exchange and a Trading Exchange. The main difference is that
some Document Exchanges implement part or all of two Trading Exchanges
David Burdett et al. [Page 202]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
simultaneously in order to minimise the number of actual OTP Messages
which must be sent over the Internet.
The six Document Exchanges are:
o Authentication. This is a direct implementation of the
Authentication Trading Exchange
o Brand Dependent Offer. This is the Offer Trading Exchange
combined with the Brand Selection part of the Payment Trading
Exchange. Its purpose is to provide the Merchant with
information on the Brand selected so that the content of the
Offer Response may be adapted accordingly
o Brand Independent Offer. This is also an Offer Trading
Exchange. However, in this instance, the content of the Offer
Response does depend on the Brand selected.
o Payment. This is a direct implementation of the Payment part of
a Payment Trading Exchange
o Delivery. This is a direct implementation of the Delivery
Exchange
o Delivery with Payment. This is an implementation of combined
Payment and Delivery Trading Exchanges
These Document Exchanges are combined together in different sequences
to implement each IOTP Transaction. The way in which they may be
combined is illustrated by the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 203]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -----------------------------------------------------
| v
| ----------------
| | AUTHENTICATION |
| ----------------
-------------------------------------- | |
| | | |
| -------------- | ------------- |
v v v v |
------------------- ----------------- |
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT | |
| OFFER | | OFFER | |
------------------- ----------------- |
| | | | |
| --------------- | | |
| | | | |
| -------------- | -- | |
v v v v |
--------- -------------- |
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH | |
| (first) | | DELIVERY | |
--------- -------------- |
| | |
----------------------------- | |
v v | | |
---------- --------- | | |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | | | |
| | | {second)| | | |
---------- --------- | | |
| | | | v
----------------------------------------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 19 Payment and Authentication Message Flow Combinations
The combinations of Document Exchanges that are valid depend on the
particular IOTP transaction.
The remainder of this sub-section describes:
o each Document Exchange in more detail including descriptions of
the content of each Trading Block in the Document Exchanges,
and
David Burdett et al. [Page 204]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o descriptions of how each IOTP Transaction uses the Document
Exchange to effect the desired result.
[Note] The descriptions of the Document Exchanges which follow
describe the ways in which various Business Errors (see
section 4.2) are handled. No reference is made however to
the handling of Technical Errors (see section 4.1) in any of
the messages since these are handled the same way
irrespective of the context in which the message is being
sent. See section 4 for more details.
[Note End]
8.1.1 Authentication Document Exchange
The Authentication Document Exchange is a direct implementation of the
Authentication Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.4). It involves:
o an Authenticator - the organisation which is requesting the
authentication, and
o an Authenticatee - the organisation being authenticated.
The authentication consists of:
o an Authentication Request being sent by the Authenticator to
the Authenticatee,
o an Authentication Response being sent in return by the
Authenticatee to the Authenticator which is then checked, and
o an Authentication Status being sent by the Authenticator to the
Authenticatee to provide an indication of the success or
failure of the authentication.
An Authentication Document Exchange also:
o provides an Authenticatee with an Organisation Component which
describes the Authenticator, and
o optionally provides the Authenticator with Organisation
Components which describe the Authenticatee.
The Authentication Request may also be digitally signed which allows
the Authenticatee to verify the credentials of the Authenticator.
David Burdett et al. [Page 205]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The IOTP Messages which are involved are illustrated by the diagram
below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 206]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
ORGANISATION 1 IOTP MESSAGE ORGANISATION 2
(AUTHENTICATEE) (AUTHENTICATOR)
1. First organisation 2. The second
takes an action (for organisation generates
example by pressing a ---------------------> an Authentication
button on an HTML Authentication Need Request Block
page) which requires (outside scope of containing challenge
that the organisation IOTP) data and list of the
is authenticated Algorithms that may be
used then sends it to
the first organisation
|
v
3. IOTP aware application IotpMsg:Trans
started. If a Signature Block <-------------------- Ref Block;
is present the first TPO & Signature
organisation may use this to Authentication Block; TPO
check the credentials of the Request Block; Auth.
second organisation. If it is Request Block;
OK the first organisation
selects an Algorithm then
uses the challenge data and
the authentication method
selected from the
Authentication Request Block
to generate an Authentication
Response Block and optional
Organisation and Signature
Components which are sent
back to the second
organisation for validation.
|
v
IotpMsg: Trans 4. The second organisation
Ref Block; ----------------------> checks the Authentication
Signature Authentication Response Response against the
Block; Auth challenge data in the
Response Block; Authentication Request Block
Organisation Block to check that the first
| organisation is who they
v appear to be, and sends an
STOP Authentication Status Block
to the first Organisation to
indicate the Result then
stops.
David Burdett et al. [Page 207]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
|
v
5. The first organisation IotpMsg: Trans
checks the Authentication <-------------------- Ref Block;
Status Block and optionally Authentication Status Signature Block;
keeps information on the IOTP Auth Response
Transaction for record Block
keeping purposes and stops. |
v v
STOP STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 20 Authentication Document Exchange
8.1.1.1 Message Processing Guidelines
On receiving a TPO & Authentication Request IOTP Message (see below),
an Authenticatee may either:
o generate and send an Authentication Response IOTP Message back
to the Authenticator, or
o indicate failure to comply with the Authentication Request by
sending a Cancel Block back to the Authenticator containing a
Status Component with a StatusType of Authentication a
ProcessState of Failed and the CompletionCode (see section
6.14.4) set to either: AutEeCancel, NoAuthData, TradRolesIncon
or Unspecified.
On receiving an Authentication Response IOTP Message (see below), an
Authenticator should send in return, an Authentication Status IOTP
Message (see below) containing a Status Block with a Status Component
where the StatusType is set to Authentication, and:
o the ProcessState attribute of the Status Component is set to
CompletedOk which indicates a successful completion, or
o the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed and the
CompletionCode attribute is set to either: AutOrCancel,
AuthFailed or Unspecified which indicates a failed
authentication,
On receiving an Authentication Status IOTP Message (see below), the
Authenticatee should check the Status Component in the Status Block.
If this indicates:
David Burdett et al. [Page 208]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a successful authentication, then the Authenticatee should
either:
- continue with the next step in the IOTP Transaction of which the
Authentication Document Exchange is part (if any), or
- indicate a failure to continue with the rest of the IOTP
Transaction, by sending back to the Authenticator a Cancel block
containing a Status Component with a StatusType of Authentication,
a ProcessState of Failed and the CompletionCode (see section
6.14.4) set to AutEeCancel.
o a failed authentication, then the failure should be reported to
the Authenticatee and any further processing stopped.
If the Authenticator receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel
block, then the Authenticatee is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn
specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component
for the Authenticator contained in the Authentication Request Block.
8.1.1.2 TPO & Authentication Request IOTP Message
Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this
message consists of:
o a Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 7.1)
o an Authentication Request Block (see section 7.4), and
o an optional Signature Block (see section 7.16).
Each of these are described below.
TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS BLOCK
The Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 7.1) must contain the
following Trading Components:
o one Protocol Options Component (see Section 6.1) which defines
the options which apply to the whole Authentication Document
Exchange.
o one Organisation Component (see section 6.5) which describes
the Authenticator. The Trading Role on the Organisation
Component should indicate the role which the Authenticator is
taking in the Trade, for example a Merchant or a Consumer.
David Burdett et al. [Page 209]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST BLOCK
The Authentication Request Block (see section 7.4) must contain the
following Trading Components:
o one Authentication Data Component (see section 6.2), and
SIGNATURE BLOCK (AUTHENTICATION REQUEST)
If the Authentication Request is being digitally signed then a
Signature Block must be included. It contains Digests of the following
XML elements:
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message that contains information that describes the IOTP
Message and IOTP Transaction
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally
uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction
o the following components of the TPO Block :
- the Protocol Options Component
- the Organisation Component
o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:
- the Authentication Data Component
8.1.1.3 Authentication Response IOTP Message
Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this
message consists of:
o an Authentication Response Block (see section 7.5), and
o an optional Signature Block (see section 7.16).
Each of these are described below.
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE BLOCK
The Authentication Response Block must contain the following Trading
Component:
o one Authentication Response Component (see section 6.3)
David Burdett et al. [Page 210]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o one Organisation Component for every Trading Role identified in
the TradingRoleList attribute of the Authentication Data
Component contained in the Authentication Request Block.
SIGNATURE BLOCK (AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE)
If the AuthMethod attribute of the Authentication Data Component
contained in the Authentication Request Block indicates that the
Authentication Response should consist of a digital signature then a
Signature Block must be included in the same IOTP message that
contains an Authentication Response Block. The Signature Component
contains Digest Elements for the following XML elements:
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message that contains information that describes the IOTP
Message and IOTP Transaction
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally
uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction
o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:
- the Authentication Data Component
o the Organisation Components contained in the Authentication
Response Block
[Note] It should not be assumed that all trading roles can support
the signing of data. Particularly it should not be assumed
that Consumers support the signing of data.
[Note End]
8.1.1.4 Authentication Status IOTP Message
Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this
message consists of:
o an Authentication Status Block (see section 7.5), and
o an optional Signature Block (see section 7.16).
Each of these are described below.
AUTHENTICATION STATUS BLOCK
The Authentication Status Block (see section 7.6) must contain the
following Trading Components:
David Burdett et al. [Page 211]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o one Status Component (see section 6.14) with a ProcessState
attribute set to CompletedOk.
SIGNATURE BLOCK (AUTHENTICATION STATUS)
If the Authentication Status Block is being digitally signed then a
Signature Block must be included that contains a Signature Component
with Digest elements for the following XML elements:
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message that contains information that describes the IOTP
Message and IOTP Transaction
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally
uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction
o the following components of the Authentication Status Block:
- the Status Component (see section 6.14).
[Note] If the Authentication Document Exchange is followed by an
Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2) then the
Authentication Status Block and the Signature Block
(Authentication Status) may be combined with either:
o a TPO IOTP Message (see section 8.1.2.3), or
o a TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message (see section
8.1.2.6)
[Note End]
8.1.2 Offer Document Exchange
The Offer Document Exchange occurs in two basic forms:
o Brand Dependent Offer Exchange. Where the content of the offer,
e.g. the order details, amount, delivery details, etc., are
dependent on the payment brand and protocol selected by the
consumer, and
o Brand Independent Offer Exchange. Where the content of the
offer is not dependent on the payment brand and protocol
selected.
Each of these types of Offer Document Exchange may be preceded by an
Authentication Document Exchange (see section 8.1.1).
David Burdett et al. [Page 212]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
8.1.2.1 Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange
In a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange the TPO Block and the
Offer Response Block are sent separately by the Merchant to the
Consumer, i.e.:
o the Brand List Component is sent to the Consumer in a TPO
Block,
o the Consumer selects a Payment Brand, Payment Protocol and
optionally a Currency and amount from the Brand List Component
o the Consumer sends the selected brand, protocol and
currency/amount back to the Merchant in a TPO Selection Block,
and
o the Merchant uses the information received to define the
content of and then send the Offer Response Block to the
Consumer.
This is illustrated by the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 213]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE MERCHANT
1. Consumer decides 2. Merchant decides which
to trade and sends payment brand protocols ,
information that -------------------> curencies and amounts
enables the Merchant Offer Information apply, places them in a
to create an offer (outside scope of Brand List Component in a
to the Merchant, IOTP) TPO Block, and sends to
e.g. using HTML Consumer
|
v
3. IOTP aware application IotpMsg:Trans
started. Consumer selects the <------------------- Ref Block; TPO
payment brand, payment protocol TPO Block
and currency/amount to use,
records selection in a Brand
Selection Component, and sends
back to Merchant
|
v
IotpMsg: Trans 4. Merchant uses selected
Ref Block; TPO --------------------> payment brand, payment
Selection Block TPO Selection protocol, currency/amount and
the offer information to
create an Offer Response Block
containing details about the
IOTP Transaction including
price, etc. optionally signs
it and sends to Consumer
|
v
5. Consumer checks Offer is OK, IotpMsg: Trans
combines components from the TPO Ref Block;
Block, the TPO Selection Block and <---------------- Signature
the Offer Response Block to create Offer Response Block; Offer
the next IOTP Message for the Response Block
Transaction and sends it together
with the Signature Block if present
to the required Trading Role
|
v
CONTINUED
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 21 Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange
David Burdett et al. [Page 214]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Note, a Consumer identifies a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange,
by the absence of an Offer Response Block in the first IOTP Message.
MESSAGE PROCESSING GUIDELINES
On receiving a TPO IOTP Message (see below), the Consumer may either:
o generate and send a TPO Selection IOTP Message back to the
Merchant, or
o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by
sending a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status
Component with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed
and the CompletionCode (see section 6.14.4) set to either:
ConsCancelled or Unspecified.
On receiving a TPO Selection IOTP Message (see below) the Merchant may
either:
o generate and send an Offer Response IOTP Message back to the
Consumer, or
o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by
sending a Cancel Block back to the Consumer containing a Status
Component with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed
and the CompletionCode (see section 6.14.4) set to either:
MerchCancelled or Unspecified.
On receiving an Offer Response IOTP Message (see below) the Consumer
may either:
o generate and send the next IOTP Message in the IOTP transaction
and send it to the required Trading Role. This is dependent on
the IOTP Transaction, or
o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by
sending a Cancel Block back to the Consumer containing a Status
Component with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed
and the CompletionCode (see section 6.14.4) set to either:
ConsCancelled or Unspecified.
If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on
the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the
Merchant.
David Burdett et al. [Page 215]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported
to the Consumer but no further action taken.
8.1.2.2 Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange
In a Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange the TPO Block and the
Offer Response Block are sent together by the Merchant to the
Consumer, i.e. there is one IOTP Message that contains both a TPO
Block, and an Offer Response Block.
The message flow is illustrated by the diagram below:
David Burdett et al. [Page 216]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE MERCHANT
1. Consumer 2. Merchant decides which
decides to payment brand, protocols ,
trade and sends --------------------> currencies and amounts apply,
information Offer Information places them in a Brand List
that enables (outside scope of Component in a TPO Block,
the Merchant to IOTP) creates an Offer Response
create an offer Block containing details about
to the the IOTP Transaction including
Merchant, e.g. price, etc, optionally signs
using HTML it and sends to Consumer
|
v
3. IOTP aware application IotpMsg: Trans Ref
started. Consumer selects the <------------- Block; Signature
payment brand and payment TPO & Block; TPO Block;
protocol to use, records Offer Response Offer Response Block
selection in a Brand Selection
Component, checks Offer is OK,
combines the Brand Selection
Component with information from
the TPO Block and Offer Response
Block to create the next IOTP
Message for the Transaction and
sends it together with the
Signature Block if present to
the required Trading Role
|
v
CONTINUED
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 22 Brand Independent Offer Exchange
Note that a Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange always occurs
when only one payment brand, protocol and currency/amount is being
offered to the Consumer by the Merchant. It is also likely to, but
will not necessarily, occur when multiple brands are being offered,
the Payment Handler is the same, and all brands use the same set of
protocols.
Note that the TPO Block and the Offer Response Block can be sent in
separate IOTP messages (see Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange)
David Burdett et al. [Page 217]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
even if the Offer Response Block does not change. However this
increases the number of messages in the transaction and is therefore
likely to increase transaction response times.
IOTP aware applications supporting the Consumer Trading Role must
check for the existence of an Offer Response Block in the first IOTP
Message to determine whether the Offer Document Exchange is brand
dependent or not.
MESSAGE PROCESSING GUIDELINES
On receiving a TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message (see below), the
Consumer may either:
o generate and send the next IOTP Message in the IOTP transaction
and send it to the required Trading Role. This is dependent on
the IOTP Transaction, or
o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by
sending a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status
Component with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed
and the CompletionCode (see section 6.14.1) set to either:
ConsCancelled or Unspecified.
If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on
the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the
Merchant.
8.1.2.3 TPO IOTP Message
The TPO IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Dependent Offer
Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see
section 3.3), this message consists of just a Trading Protocol Options
Block (see section 7.1) which is described below.
TPO (TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS) BLOCK
The Trading Protocol Options Block must contain the following Trading
Components:
o one Protocol Options Component which defines the options which
apply to the whole IOTP Transaction. See Section 6.1.
o one Brand List Component (see section 6.6) for each Payment in
the IOTP Transaction that contain one or more payment brands
and protocols which may be selected for use in each payment
David Burdett et al. [Page 218]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Organisation Components (see section 6.5) with the following
roles:
- Merchant who is making the offer
- Consumer who is carrying out the transaction
- the PaymentHandler(s) for the payment. The "ID" of the Payment
Handler Organisation Component is contained within the PhOrgRef
attribute of the Payment Component
If the IOTP Transaction includes a Delivery then the TPO Block must
also contain:
o Organisation Components with the following roles:
- DeliveryHandler who will be delivering the goods or services
- DelivTo i.e. the person or organisation which is to take delivery
AUTHENTICATION STATUS AND SIGNATURE BLOCKS
If the Offer Document Exchange was preceded by an Authentication
Document Exchange, then the TPO IOTP Message may also contain:
o an Authentication Status Block (see section 7.6), and
o an optional Signature Block (Authentication Status) Signature
Block
See section 8.1.1.4 Authentication Status IOTP Message for more
details.
8.1.2.4 TPO Selection IOTP Message
The TPO Selection IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Dependent
Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see
section 3.3), this message consists of just a TPO Selection Block (see
section 7.1) which is described below.
TPO SELECTION BLOCK
The TPO Selection Block (see section 7.2) contains:
o one Brand Selection Component (see section 6.7) for use in a
later Payment Exchange. It contains the results of the consumer
selecting a Payment Brand, Payment Protocol and currency/amount
from the list provided in the Brand List Component.
David Burdett et al. [Page 219]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
8.1.2.5 Offer Response IOTP Message
The Offer Response IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Dependent
Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see
section 3.3), this message consists of:
o an Offer Response Block (see section 7.1) and
o an optional Signature Block (see section 7.16).
OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK
The Offer Response Block (see section 7.3) contains the following
components:
o one Status Component (see section 6.14) which indicates the
status of the Offer Response. The ProcessState attribute should
be set to CompletedOk
o one Order Component (see section 6.4) which contains details
about the goods and services which are being purchased or the
financial transaction which is taking place
o one or more Payment Component(s) (see section 6.8) for each
payment which is to be made
o zero or one Delivery Components (see section 6.12) containing
details of the delivery to be made if the IOTP Transaction
includes a delivery
o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 6.15) if
required by the Merchant.
SIGNATURE BLOCK (OFFER RESPONSE)
If the Authentication Status Block is being digitally signed then a
Signature Block must be included that contains a Signature Component
(see section 6.17) with Digest Elements for the following XML
elements:
If the Offer Response is being digitally signed then a Signature Block
must be included that contains a Signature Component (see section
6.17) with Digest Elements for the following XML elements:
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message that contains information that describes the IOTP
Message and IOTP Transaction
David Burdett et al. [Page 220]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally
uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction
o the following components of the TPO Block :
- the Protocol Options Component, and
- the Brand List Component
- all the Organisation Components present
o the following components of the Offer Response Block:
- the Order Component
- all the Payment Components present
- the Delivery Component if present
- any Trading Role Data Components present
8.1.2.6 TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message
The TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message is only used with a Brand
Independent Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction
Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:
o a Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 7.1)
o an Offer Response Block (see section 7.1) and
o an optional Signature Block (see section 7.16).
TPO (TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS) BLOCK
This is the same as the Trading Protocol Options Block described in
TPO IOTP Message (see section 8.1.2.3).
OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK
This the same as the Offer Response Block in the Offer Response IOTP
Message (see section 8.1.2.5).
AUTHENTICATION STATUS
If the Offer Document Exchange was preceded by an Authentication
Document Exchange, then the TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message may
also contain an Authentication Status Block (see section 7.6).
SIGNATURE BLOCK
This is the same as the Signature Block in the Offer Response IOTP
Message (see section 8.1.2.5) with the addition that:
David Burdett et al. [Page 221]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o if the Offer Document Exchange is Brand Dependent then the
Signature Component in the Signature Block additionally
contains a Digest Element for the Brand Selection Component
contained in the TPO Selection Block
o if the Offer Document Exchange was preceded by an
Authentication Document Exchange then the Signature Component
in the Signature Block additionally contains a Digest Element
for the Authentication Status Block.
8.1.3 Payment Document Exchange
The Payment Document Exchange is a direct implementation of the last
part of a Payment Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.2) after the Brand
has been selected by the Consumer. A Payment Exchange consists of:
o the Consumer requesting that a payment starts by generating
Payment Request IOTP Message using information from previous
IOTP Messages in the Transaction and then sending it to the
Payment Handler
o the Payment Handler and the Consumer then swapping Payment
Exchange IOTP Messages encapsulating payment protocol messages
until the payment is complete, and finally
o the Payment Handler sending a Payment Response IOTP Message to
the Consumer containing a receipt for the payment.
David Burdett et al. [Page 222]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The IOTP Messages which are involved are illustrated by the diagram
below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE PAYMENT HANDLER
1. Consumer generates Pay Request
Block encapsulating a payment
protocol message if required and
sends to Payment Handler with the
Signature Block if present
|
v
IotpMsg: Trans 2. Payment Handler processes Pay
Ref Block; -------------> Request Block, checks optional
Signature Block; Payment signature and starts exchanging
ay Request Block Request payment protocol messages,
encapsulated in a Pay Exchange
Block, with the Consumer
|
v
Consumer keeps <- ----->IotpMsg: IotpMsg: Trans
on exchanging Pay Trans Ref <-----------------> Ref Block; Pay
xchange Blocks with Block; Pay Payment Exchange Exchange Block
Payment Handler Exchange Block
|
v
4. Eventually payment protocol
messages finish so Payment Handler
creates Pay Receipt Component inside
a Pay Response Block, and an
optional Signature Component inside
the Signature Block, sends to
Consumer and stops
|
v
5. Consumer checks Pay Response is IotpMsg: Trans
OK. Optionally keeps information on <--------------- Ref Block;
OTP Transaction for record keeping Payment Response Signature Block
purposes and either stops or Pay Response
creates the next IOTP Message for Block
the Transaction and sends it
together with the Signature Block
if present to the required Trading
Role
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
David Burdett et al. [Page 223]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Figure 23 Payment Document Exchange
8.1.3.1 Message Processing Guidelines
On receiving a Payment Request IOTP Message, the Payment Handler
should check that they are authorised to carry out the Payment (see
section 5 Security Considerations). They may then either:
o generate and send a Payment Exchange IOTP Message back to the
Consumer, if more payment protocol messages need to be
exchanged, or
o generate and send a Payment Response IOTP Message if the
exchange of payment protocol messages is complete, or
o indicate failure to continue with the Payment by sending a
Cancel Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component
with a StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of Failed and the
CompletionCode (see section 6.14.4) set to either:
BrandNotSupp, CurrNotSupp, PaymtCancelled, AuthError,
InsuffFunds, InstBrandInvalid, InstNotValid, BadInstrument or
Unspecified.
On receiving a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Consumer may either:
o generate and send a Payment Exchange Message back to the
Payment Handler or
o indicate failure to continue with the Payment by sending a
Cancel Block back to the Payment Handler containing a Status
Component with a StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of
Failed and the CompletionCode (see section 6.14.2) set to
either: ConsCancelled or Unspecified.
On receiving a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Payment Handler may
either:
o generate and send a Payment Exchange IOTP Message back to the
Consumer, if more payment protocol messages need to be
exchanged, or
o generate and send a Payment Response IOTP Message if the
exchange of payment protocol messages is complete, or
o indicate failure to continue with the Payment by sending a
Cancel Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component
David Burdett et al. [Page 224]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
with a StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of Failed and the
CompletionCode (see section 6.14.2) set to either:
PaymtCancelled or Unspecified.
On receiving a Payment Response IOTP Message, the Consumer may either:
o generate and send the next IOTP Message in the IOTP transaction
and send it to the required Trading Role. This is dependent on
the IOTP Transaction,
o stop, since the IOTP Transaction has ended, or
o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by
sending a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status
Component with a StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of
Failed and the CompletionCode (see section 6.14.1) set to
either: ConsCancelled or Unspecified.
If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported
to the Consumer but no further action taken.
If the Payment Handler receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel
block, then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn
specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component
for the Payment Handler from which any further action may take place.
If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the Consumer should have completed the payment but not continuing
with the transaction for some reason. In this case the Consumer is
likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role
Element in the Organisation Component for the Merchant from which any
further action may take place.
8.1.3.2 Payment Request IOTP Message
Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this
message consists of:
o a Payment Request Block, and
o an optional Signature Block
PAYMENT REQUEST BLOCK
The Payment Request Block (see section 7.7) contains:
David Burdett et al. [Page 225]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the following components copied from the Offer Response Block
from the preceding Offer Document Exchange:
- the Status Component
- the Payment Component for the payment which is being carried out
- the Organisation Components with the roles of Merchant and for the
PaymentHandler that is being sent the Payment Request Block
o the following component from the TPO Block:
- the Brand List Component for the payment, i.e. the Brand List
referred to by the BrandListRef attribute on the Payment Component
o one Brand Selection Component for the Brand List, i.e. the
Brand Selection Component where BrandListRef attribute points
to the Brand List. This component can be either:
- copied from the TPO Selection Block if the payment was preceded by
a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2.1),
or
- created by the Consumer, containing the payment brand, payment
protocol and currency/amount selected from the Brand List, if the
payment was preceded by a Brand Independent Offer Document
Exchange (see section 8.1.2.2)
o an optional Payment Scheme Component (see section 6.9) if
required by the payment method used (see the Payment Method
supplement to determine if this is needed).
o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 6.15).
Note that:
o if there is more than one Payment Components in an Offer
Response Block, then the second payment is the one within the
Offer Response Block that contains a StartAfter attribute (see
section 6.8) that identifies the Payment Component for the
first payment
o the Payment Handler to include is identified by the Brand
Selection Component (see section 6.7) for the payment. Also see
section 5.3.1 Check the Action Request was sent to the Correct
Organisation for an explanation on how Payment Handlers are
identified
o the Brand List Component to include is the one identified by
the BrandListRef attribute of the Payment Component for the
identified payment
David Burdett et al. [Page 226]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the Brand Selection Component to include from the Offer
Response Block is the one that contains an BrandListRef
attribute (see section 3.5) which identifies the Brand List
Component for the second payment.
SIGNATURE BLOCK (PAYMENT REQUEST)
If the either the preceding Offer Document Exchange included an Offer
Response Signature (see section 8.1.2.5 Offer Response IOTP Message),
or a preceding Payment Exchange included a Payment Response Signature
(see section 8.1.3.4 Payment Response IOTP Message) then they should
both be copied to the Signature Block in the Payment Request IOTP
Message.
8.1.3.3 Payment Exchange IOTP Message
Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this
message consists of just a Payment Exchange Block.
PAYMENT EXCHANGE BLOCK
The Payment Exchange Block (see section 7.8) contains:
o one Payment Scheme Component (see section 6.9) which contains
payment method specific data. See the Payment Method supplement
for the payment method being used to determine what this should
contain.
8.1.3.4 Payment Response IOTP Message
Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this
message consists of:
o a Payment Response Block, and
o an optional Signature Block
PAYMENT RESPONSE BLOCK
The Payment Response Block (see section 7.9) contains:
o one Payment Receipt Component (see section 6.10) which contains
scheme specific data which can be used to verify the payment
occurred
o one Payment Scheme Component (see section 6.9) if required
which contains payment method specific data. See the Payment
David Burdett et al. [Page 227]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
Method supplement for the payment method being used to
determine what this should contain
o an optional Payment Note Component (see section 6.11)
o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 6.15).
SIGNATURE BLOCK (PAYMENT RESPONSE)
If a signed Payment Receipt is being provided, indicated by the
SignedPayReceipt attribute of the Payment Component being set to True,
then the Signature Block should contain a Signature Component which
contains Digest Elements for the following:
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP
Message which contains the first usage of the Payment Response
Block,
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) within the
Transaction Reference Block that globally uniquely identifies
the IOTP Transaction,
o the Payment Receipt Component from the Payment Response Block,
o the other Components referenced by the PayReceiptRefs attribute
(if present) of the Payment Receipt Component,
o the Status Component from the Payment Response Block,
o any Trading Role Data Components in the Payment Response Block,
and
o all the Signature Components contained in the Payment Request
Block if present.
8.1.4 Delivery Document Exchange
The Delivery Document Exchange is a direct implementation of a
Delivery Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.3). It consists of:
o the Consumer requesting a Delivery by generating Delivery
Request IOTP Message using information from previous IOTP
Messages in the Transaction and then sending it to the Delivery
Handler
David Burdett et al. [Page 228]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the Delivery Handler sending a Delivery Response IOTP Message
to the Consumer containing details about the Handler's response
to the request together with an optional signature.
The message flow is illustrated by the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE DELIVERY HANDLER
1. Consumer generates 2. Delivery Handler
Delivery Request checks the Status and
Block and sends it to ---------------------> Order Components in the
the Delivery Handler Delivery Request Delivery Request and
with the Signature the optional
Block if present Signatures, creates a
Delivery Response
Block, sends to
Consumer and stops
|
v
3. Consumer checks Delivery IotpMsg:Trans
Response Block is OK, <-------------------- Ref Block;
optionally keeps information Delivery Response Delivery
on IOTP Transaction for Response Block
record keeping purposes and
stops
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 24 Delivery Document Exchange
8.1.4.1 Message Processing Guidelines
On receiving a Delivery Request IOTP Message, the Delivery Handler
should check that they are authorised to carry out the Delivery (see
section 5 Security Considerations). They may then either:
o generate and send a Delivery Response IOTP Message to the
Consumer, or
o indicate failure to continue with the Delivery by sending a
Cancel Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component
with a StatusType of Delivery, a ProcessState of Failed and the
CompletionCode (see section 6.14.4) set to either:
DelivCanceled, or Unspecified.
David Burdett et al. [Page 229]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
On receiving a Delivery Response IOTP Message, the Consumer should
just stop since the IOTP Transaction is complete.
If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported
to the Consumer but no further action taken.
8.1.4.2 Delivery Request IOTP Message
The Delivery Request IOTP Message consists of:
o a Delivery Request Block, and
o an optional Signature Block
DELIVERY REQUEST BLOCK
The Delivery Request Block (see section 7.10) contains:
o the following components copied from the Offer Response Block:
- the Status Component (see section 6.14)
- the Order Component (see section 6.4)
- the Organisation Component (see section 6.5) with the roles of:
Merchant, DeliveryHandler and DeliverTo
- the Delivery Component (see section 6.12)
o the following Component from the Payment Response Block:
- the Status Component (see section 6.14).
o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 6.15).
SIGNATURE BLOCK (DELIVERY REQUEST)
If the preceding Offer Document Exchange included an Offer Response
Signature or the Payment Document Exchange included a Payment Response
Signature, then they should both be copied to the Signature Block.
8.1.4.3 Delivery Response IOTP Message
The Delivery Response IOTP Message contains a Delivery Response Block
and an options Signature Block.
DELIVERY RESPONSE BLOCK
The Delivery Response Block contains:
David Burdett et al. [Page 230]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o one Delivery Note Component (see section 6.13) which contains
delivery instructions about the delivery of goods or services
SIGNATURE BLOCK (DELIVERY RESPONSE)
The Signature Block should contain one Signature Component that
contains Digest elements that refer to
o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP
message that contains the Delivery Response Signature
o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP
Message that contains the Delivery Response Signature
o the Signature Components contained in the Delivery Request (if
any)
o the Status Component
o the Delivery Note Component
8.1.5 Payment and Delivery Document Exchange
The Payment and Delivery Document Exchange is a combination of the
last part of the Payment Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.2) and a
Delivery Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.3). It consists of:
o the Consumer requesting that a payment starts by generating
Payment Request IOTP Message using information from previous
IOTP Messages in the Transaction and then sending it to the
Payment Handler
o the Payment Handler and the Consumer then swapping Payment
Exchange IOTP Messages encapsulating payment protocol messages
until the payment is complete, and finally
o the Payment Handler sending to the Consumer in one IOTP
Message:
- a Payment Response Block containing a receipt for the payment, and
- a Delivery Response Block containing details of the goods or
services to be delivered
The IOTP Messages which are involved are illustrated by the diagram
below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 231]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE MERCHANT
1. Consumer generates Pay Request
Block encapsulating a payment
protocol message if required and
sends to Payment Handler with the
Signature Block if present
|
v
IotpMsg: Trans 2. Payment Handler processes Pay
Ref Block; -------------> Request Block, checks optional
Signature Block; Payment signature and starts exchanging
ay Request Block Request payment protocol messages,
encapsulated in a Pay Exchange
Block, with the Consumer
|
v
Consumer keeps <------->IotpMsg: IotpMsg: Trans
on exchanging Pay Trans Ref <-----------------> Ref Block; Pay
Exchange Blocks with Block; Pay Payment Exchange Exchange Block
Payment Handler Exchange Block
|
v
4. Eventually payment protocol
messages finish so Payment Handler
creates Pay Receipt Component inside
a Pay Response Block and an optional
Signature Component, then uses
information from the Offer Response
Block to create a Delivery Response
Block, sends both to Consumer and
stops
|
v
5. Consumer checks Pay Response IotpMsg: Trans
and Delivery Response Blocks are <--------------- Ref Block;
OK, optionally keeps information Payment Response Signature Block
on IOTP Transaction for record & Delivery Pay Response
keeping purposes and stops Response Block; Delivery
Response Block
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 25 Payment and Delivery Document Exchange
David Burdett et al. [Page 232]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
The Delivery Response Block and the Payment Response Block may be
combined into the same IOTP Message only if the Payment Handler has
the information available so that she can send the Delivery Response
Block. This is likely to, but will not necessarily, occur when the
Merchant, the Payment Handler and the Delivery Handler Roles are
combined.
The DelivAndPayResp attribute of the Delivery Component (see section
6.12) contained within the Offer Response Block (see section 7.3) is
set to True if the Delivery Response Block and the Payment Response
Block are combined into the same IOTP Message and is set to False if
the Delivery Response Block and the Payment Response Block are sent in
separate IOTP Messages.
8.1.5.1 Message Processing Guidelines
On receiving a Payment Request IOTP Message or a Payment Exchange IOTP
Message, the Payment Handler should carry out the same actions as for
a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3.1).
On receiving a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Consumer should also
carry out the same actions as for a Payment Document Exchange (see
section 8.1.3.1).
On receiving a Payment Response and Delivery Response IOTP Message
then the IOTP Transaction is complete and should take no further
action.
If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported
to the Consumer but no further action taken.
If the Payment Handler receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel
block, then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn
specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component
for the Payment Handler from which any further action may take place.
If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block,
then the Consumer should have completed the payment but not continuing
with the transaction for some reason. In this case the Consumer is
likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role
Element in the Organisation Component for the Merchant from which any
further action may take place.
David Burdett et al. [Page 233]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
8.1.5.2 Payment Request IOTP Message
The content of this message is the same as for a Payment Request IOTP
Message in a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3.2)
8.1.5.3 Payment Exchange IOTP Message
The content of this message is the same as for a Payment Exchange IOTP
Message in a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3.3).
8.1.5.4 Payment Response and Delivery Response IOTP Message
The content of this message consists of:
o a Payment Response Block,
o an optional Signature Block (Payment Response), and
o a Delivery Response Block.
PAYMENT RESPONSE BLOCK
The content of this block is the same as the Payment Response Block in
the Payment Response IOTP Message associated with a Payment Document
Exchange (see section 8.1.3.4).
SIGNATURE BLOCK (PAYMENT RESPONSE)
The content of this block is the same as the Signature Block (Payment
Response) in the Payment Response IOTP Message associated with a
Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3.4).
DELIVERY RESPONSE BLOCK
The content of this block is the same as the Delivery Response Block
in the Delivery Response IOTP Message associated with a Delivery
Document Exchange (see section 8.1.4.3).
8.1.6 Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction
A Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction may occur at any time
between any of the Trading Roles involved in OTP Transactions. This
means it could occur:
o before another IOTP Transaction
David Burdett et al. [Page 234]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o at the same time as another IOTP Transaction
o independently of any other IOTP Transaction.
The Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction consists of just an
Authentication Document Exchange (see section 8.1.1) as illustrated by
the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -------------------------------------------------------
v
----------------
| AUTHENTICATION |
----------------
|
|
|
|
------------------- ----------------- |
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT | |
| OFFER | | OFFER | |
------------------- ----------------- |
|
|
|
|
|
--------- -------------- |
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH | |
| (first) | | DELIVERY | |
--------- -------------- |
|
|
|
---------- --------- |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | |
| | | {second)| |
---------- --------- |
v
STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 26 Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction
Example uses of the Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction include:
David Burdett et al. [Page 235]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o when the Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction takes place
as an early part of a session where strong continuity exists.
For example, a Financial Institution could:
- set up a secure channel (e.g. using SSL) with a customer
- authenticate the customer using the Baseline Authentication IOTP
Transaction, and then
- provide the customer with access to account information and other
services with the confidence that they are communicating with a
bona fide customer.
o as a means of providing a Merchant role with Organisation
Components that contain information about Consumer and DelivTo
Trading Roles
o so that a Consumer may authenticate a Payment Handler before
starting a payment.
8.1.7 Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction
The Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction supports the deposit of
electronic cash with a Financial Institution.
[Note] The Financial Institution has, in IOTP terminology, a role
of merchant in that a service (i.e. a deposit of electronic
cash) is being offered in return for a fee, for example bank
charges of some kind. The term "Financial Institution" is
used in the diagrams and in the text for clarity.
[Note End]
The Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction consists of the following
Document Exchanges:
o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section
8.1.1)
o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2), and
o a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3).
The way in which these Document Exchanges may be combined together is
illustrated by the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 236]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -----------------------------------------------------
| v
| ----------------
| | AUTHENTICATION |
| ----------------
-------------------------------------- |
| | |
| -------------- | -------------
v v v v
------------------- -----------------
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT |
| OFFER | | OFFER |
------------------- -----------------
| |
| |
| |
| -------------------
v v
--------- --------------
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH |
| (first) | | DELIVERY |
--------- --------------
|
----------------
|
---------- --------- |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | |
| | | {second)| |
---------- --------- |
|
-----------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 27 Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction
See section 8.1.12 _Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges_ to
determine which combination of document exchanges apply to a
particular instance of an IOTP Transaction
Note that:
o a Merchant (Financial Institution) may be able to accept a
deposit in several different types of electronic cash although,
David Burdett et al. [Page 237]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
since the Consumer role that is depositing the electronic cash
usually knows what type of cash they want to deposit, it is
usually constrained in practice to only one type. However,
there may be several different protocols which may be used for
the same "brand" of electronic cash. In this case a Brand
Dependent Offer may be appropriate to negotiate the protocol to
be used.
o the Merchant (Financial Institution) may use the results of the
authentication to identify not only the consumer but also the
account to which the payment is to be deposited. If no single
account can be identified, then it must be obtained by other
means. For example:
- the consumer could specify the account number prior to the
Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction starting, or
- the consumer could have been identified earlier, for example using
a Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction, and an account
selected from a list provided by the Financial Institution.
o The Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction without an Authentication
Document Exchange might be used:
- if a previous IOTP transaction, for example a Baseline Withdrawal
or a Baseline Authentication, authenticated the consumer, and a
secure channel has been maintained, therefore the authenticity of
the consumer is known
- if authentication is achieved as part of a proprietary payment
protocol and is therefore included in the Payment Document
Exchange
- if authentication of the consumer has been achieved by some other
means outside of the scope of IOTP, for example, by using a pass
phrase, or a proprietary banking software solution.
8.1.8 Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction
The Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction supports the purchase of goods
or services using any payment method. It consists of the following
Document Exchanges:
o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section
8.1.1)
o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2)
o either:
- a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3) followed by
- a Delivery Document Exchange (see section 8.1.4)
David Burdett et al. [Page 238]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a Payment Document Exchange only, or
o a combined Payment and Delivery Document Exchange (see section
8.1.5).
The ways in which these Document Exchanges are combined is illustrated
by the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -----------------------------------------------------
| v
| ----------------
| | AUTHENTICATION |
| ----------------
-------------------------------------- | |
| | | |
| -------------- | ------------- |
v v v v |
------------------- ----------------- |
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT | |
| OFFER | | OFFER | |
------------------- ----------------- |
| | | | |
| --------------- | | |
| | | | |
| -------------- | -- | |
v v v v |
--------- -------------- |
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH | |
| (first) | | DELIVERY | |
--------- -------------- |
| | |
----------------------------- | |
v | | |
---------- --------- | | |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | | | |
| | | {second)| | | |
---------- --------- | | |
| | | v
----------------------------------------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 28 Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction
David Burdett et al. [Page 239]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
See section 8.1.12 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges to
determine which combination of document exchanges apply to a
particular instance of an IOTP Transaction
8.1.9 Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction
In business terms the refund process typically consists of:
o a request for a refund being made by the Consumer to the
Merchant, typically supported by evidence to demonstrate:
- the original trade took place, for example by providing a receipt
for the original transaction
- using some type of authentication, that the consumer requesting
the refund is the consumer, or a representative of the consumer,
who carried out the original trade
- the reason why the merchant should make the refund
o the merchant agreeing (or not) to the refund. This may involve
some negotiation between the Consumer and the Merchant, and, if
the merchant agrees,
o a refund payment by the Merchant to the Consumer.
The Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction supports a subset of the above,
specifically it supports:
o stand alone authentication of the Consumer using a separate
Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction (see section 8.1.6)
o a refund payment by the Merchant to the Consumer using the
following two Trading Exchanges:
- an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section 8.1.1)
- an Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2), and
- a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3).
The ways in which these Document Exchanges are combined is illustrated
by the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 240]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -----------------------------------------------------
| v
| ----------------
| | AUTHENTICATION |
| ----------------
-------------------------------------- |
| | |
| -------------- | -------------
v v v v
------------------- -----------------
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT |
| OFFER | | OFFER |
------------------- -----------------
| |
| |
| |
| -------------------
v v
--------- --------------
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH |
| (first) | | DELIVERY |
--------- --------------
|
----------------
|
---------- --------- |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | |
| | | {second)| |
---------- --------- |
|
-----------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 29 Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction
A Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction without an Authentication Document
Exchange might be used:
o when authentication of the consumer has been achieved by some
other means, for example, the consumer has entered some
previously supplied code in order to identify herself and the
refund to which the code applies. The code could be supplied,
for example on a web page or by e-mail.
David Burdett et al. [Page 241]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o when a previous IOTP transaction, for example a Baseline
Authentication, authenticated the consumer, and a secure
channel has been maintained, therefore the authenticity of the
consumer is known and therefore the previously agreed refund
can be identified.
o when the authentication of the consumer is carried out by the
Payment Handler using a payment scheme authentication method.
8.1.10 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction
The Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction supports the withdrawal of
electronic cash from a Financial Institution.
[Note] The Financial Institution has, in IOTP terminology, a role
of merchant in that a service (i.e. a withdrawal of
electronic cash) is being offered in return for a fee, for
example bank charges of some kind. The term "Financial
Institution" is used in the diagrams and in the text for
clarity.
[Note End]
The Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction consists of the following
Document Exchanges:
o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section
8.1.1)
o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2), and
o a Payment Document Exchange (see section 8.1.3).
The way in which these Document Exchanges may be combined together is
illustrated by the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 242]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -----------------------------------------------------
| v
| ----------------
| | AUTHENTICATION |
| ----------------
-------------------------------------- |
| | |
| -------------- | -------------
v v v v
------------------- -----------------
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT |
| OFFER | | OFFER |
------------------- -----------------
| |
| |
| |
| -------------------
v v
--------- --------------
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH |
| (first) | | DELIVERY |
--------- --------------
|
----------------
|
---------- --------- |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | |
| | | {second)| |
---------- --------- |
|
-----------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 30 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction
Note that:
o a Merchant (Financial Institution) may be able to offer
withdrawal of several different types of electronic cash. In
practice usually only one form of electronic cash may be
offered. However, there may be several different protocols
which may be used for the same "brand" of electronic cash
David Burdett et al. [Page 243]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o the Merchant (Financial Institution) may use the results of the
authentication to identify not only the consumer but also the
account from which the withdrawal is to be made. If no single
account can be identified, then it must be obtained by other
means. For example:
- the consumer could specify the account number prior to the
Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction starting, or
- the consumer could have been identified earlier, for example using
a Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction, and an account
selected from a list provided by the Financial Institution.
o a Baseline Withdrawal without an authentication might be used:
- if a previous IOTP transaction, for example a Baseline Deposit or
a Baseline Authentication, authenticated the consumer, and a
secure channel has been maintained, therefore the authenticity of
the consumer is known
- if authentication is achieved as part of a proprietary payment
protocol and is therefore included in the Payment Document
Exchange
- if authentication of the consumer has been achieved by some other
means, for example, by using a pass phrase, or a proprietary
banking software solution.
8.1.11 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction
The Baseline Value Exchange Transaction uses Payment Document
Exchanges to support the exchange of value in one currency obtained
using one payment method with value in the same or another currency
using the same or another payment method. Examples of its use include:
o electronic cash advance on a credit card. For example the first
payment could be a _dollar SET Payment_ using a credit card
with the second payment being a download of Visa Cash e-cash in
dollars.
o foreign exchange using the same payment method. For example the
payment could be an upload of Mondex value in British Pounds
and the second a download of Mondex value in Euros
o foreign exchange using different payment methods. For example
the first payment could be a SET payment in Canadian Dollars
followed a download of GeldKarte in Deutchmarks.
The Baseline Value Exchange uses the following Document Exchanges:
David Burdett et al. [Page 244]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section
8.1.1)
o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2), which provides
details of what values and currencies will be exchanged, and
o two Payment Document Exchanges (see section 8.1.3) which carry
out the two payments involved.
The way in which these Document Exchanges may be combined together is
illustrated by the diagram below.
David Burdett et al. [Page 245]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START -----------------------------------------------------
| v
| ----------------
| | AUTHENTICATION |
| ----------------
-------------------------------------- |
| | |
| -------------- | -------------
v v v v
------------------- -----------------
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT |
| OFFER | | OFFER |
------------------- -----------------
| |
| |
| |
| -------------------
v v
--------- --------------
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH |
| (first) | | DELIVERY |
--------- --------------
|
----
v
---------- ---------
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT |
| | | {second)|
---------- ---------
|
-----------------------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 31 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction
The Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction occurs in two basic
forms:
o Brand Dependent Value Exchange. Where the content of the offer,
for example the rate at which one form of value is exchanged
for another, is dependent on the payment brands and protocols
selected by the consumer, and
David Burdett et al. [Page 246]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Brand Independent Value Exchange. Where the content of the
offer is not dependent on the payment brands and protocols
selected.
[Note] In the above the role is a Merchant even though the
organisation carrying out the Value Exchange may be a Bank
or some other Financial Institution. This is because the
Bank is acting as a merchant in that they are making an
offer which the Consumer can either accept or decline.
[Note End]
The TPO Block and Offer Response Block may only be combined into the
same IOTP Message if the content of the Offer Response Block does not
change as a result of selecting the payment brands and payment
protocols to be used in the Value Exchange.
BASELINE VALUE EXCHANGE SIGNATURES
The use of signatures to ensure the integrity of a Baseline Value
Exchange is illustrated by the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Signature generated IotpMsg (TPO)
by Merchant ensures - Trans Ref Block
integrity of the Offer --------> - - Signature Block
| - TPO Block MERCHANT
| - Offer Response Block
|
Signature generated by |
the Payment Handler of | IotpMsg (Pay Resp 1)
the first payment binds | - Trans Ref Block PAYMENT
Pay Receipt for the first -----> -> - Signature Block ----- HANDLER
payment to the Offer - Pay Response Block 1 | 1
|
Signature generated by |
the Payment Handler of IotpMsg (Pay Resp 2) | PAYMENT
the second payment binds - Trans Ref Block | HANDLER
the second payment to the -----> - Signature Block <------ 2
first payment and therefore - Pay Response Block 2
to the Offer
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 32 Baseline Value Exchange Signatures
David Burdett et al. [Page 247]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
8.1.12 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges
The following diagram illustrates the data conditions in the various
IOTP messages which can be used by a Consumer Trading Role to
determine whether the combination of Document Exchanges are valid.
David Burdett et al. [Page 248]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
START
|
v
Auth Request Block in =TRUE
first IOTP Message ? ---------------------------------------
| = FALSE |
v v
Offer Response Block in ----------------
first IOTP Message ? | AUTHENTICATION |
|=TRUE |=FALSE ----------------
| | |
| | v
| ---------------------- TPO & Offer Response
------------- | Blocks in last IOTP Msg
| | |=TRUE |=FALSE
| | | v
| ------------- | ---- TPO Block only i
| | | last IOTP Message
| | | of Authentication
| | | |=TRUE |=FALSE
v v v v |
------------------- ----------------- |
| BRAND INDEPENDENT | | BRAND DEPENDENT | |
| OFFER | | OFFER | |
------------------- ----------------- |
| | |
v v |
Offer Response Block contains |
Delivery Component ? |
|=FALSE |=TRUE |
--- v |
| Value of DelivAndPayResp |
| attribute of Delivery Component ? |
| |=FALSE |=TRUE |
| | | |
v v v |
--------- -------------- |
| PAYMENT | | PAYMENT WITH | |
| (first) | | DELIVERY | |
--------- -------------- |
| | |
v | |
Offer and Response Block contains |
Delivery Component ? |
|=TRUE |=FALSE |
David Burdett et al. [Page 249]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
| v |
| Two Payment Components |
| present in Offer Response Block? |
| |=TRUE |=FALSE |
v v | |
---------- --------- | |
| DELIVERY | | PAYMENT | | |
| | | {second)| | |
---------- --------- | |
| | | v
----------------------------------------------> STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 33 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges
1) If first IOTP Message of an IOTP Transaction contains an
Authentication Request then:
a) IOTP Transaction includes an Authentication Document Exchange
(see section 8.1.1). (Note 1)
b) If the last IOTP Message of the Authentication Document
Exchange includes a TPO Block and an Offer Response Block
then:
i) IOTP Transaction includes a Brand Independent Offer
Document Exchange (see section 8.1.2.2). (Note 2)
c) Otherwise, if the last IOTP Message of the Authentication
Exchange includes a TPO Block but NO Offer Response Block,
then:
i) IOTP Transaction includes a Brand Dependent Offer Document
Exchange (see section 8.1.2.1). (Note 2)
d) Otherwise (Authentication Status IOTP Message of the
Authentication Document Exchange contains neither a TPO Block
but nor an Offer Response Block)
i) IOTP Transaction consists of just an Authentication
Document Exchange. (Note 3)
2) Otherwise (no Authentication Request in first IOTP Message):
David Burdett et al. [Page 250]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
a) IOTP Transaction does not include an Authentication Document
Exchange (Note 2)
b) If first IOTP Message contains an Offer Response Block, then:
i) the IOTP Transaction contains a Brand Independent Offer
Document Exchange (Note 2)
c) Otherwise (no Offer Response Block in first IOTP Message):
i) the IOTP Transaction includes a Brand Dependent Offer
Document Exchange (Note 2)
3) If an Offer Response Block exists in any IOTP message then:
a) If the Offer Response Block contains a Delivery Component
then:
i) If the DelivAndPayResp attribute of the Delivery Component
is set to True, then:
. the IOTP Transaction consists of a Payment And Delivery
Document Exchange (see section 8.1.5) (Note 4)
ii) otherwise (the DelivAndPayResp attribute of the Delivery
Component is set to False)
. the IOTP Transaction consists of a Payment Document
Exchange (see section 8.1.3) followed by a Delivery
Document Exchange (see section 8.1.4) (Note 4)
b) otherwise (the Offer Response Block does not contain a
Delivery Component)
i) if the Offer Response Block contains just one Payment
Component, then:
. the IOTP Transaction contains just one Payment Document
Exchange (Note 5)
ii) if the Offer Response Block contains two Payment
Components, then:
. the IOTP Transaction contains two Payment Document
Exchanges. The StartAfter attribute of the Payment
Components is used to indicate which payment occurs
first (Note 6)
David Burdett et al. [Page 251]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
iii) if the Offer Response Block contains no or more than two
Payment Components, then there is an error
4) Otherwise (no Offer Response Block) there is an error.
The following table indicates the types of IOTP Transactions which can
validly have the conditions indicated above.
Ref IOTP Transaction Validity
1. Any Payment and Authentication IOTP Transaction
2. Any Payment and Authentication IOTP Transaction except Baseline
Authentication
3. Either Baseline Authentication, or a Baseline Purchase, Refund,
Deposit, Withdrawal or Value Exchange with a failed
Authentication
4. Baseline Purchase only
5. Baseline Purchase, Refund, Deposit or Withdrawal
6. Baseline Value Exchange only
8.1.13 Combining Authentication Transactions with other Transactions
In the previous sections an Authentication Document Exchange is shown
preceding an Offer Document Exchange as part of a single IOTP
Transaction with the same OTP Transaction Id.
It is also possible to run a separate Authentication Transaction at
any point, even in parallel with another IOTP Transaction. Typically
this will be used:
o by a Consumer to authenticate a Payment Handler or a Delivery
Handler, or
o by a Payment Handler or Delivery Handler to authenticate a
Consumer.
In outline the basic process consists of:
o the Trading Role that decides it wants to carry out an
authentication of another role suspends the current IOTP
transaction being carried out
David Burdett et al. [Page 252]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a stand-alone Authentication transaction is then carried out.
This may, at implementer's option, be linked to the original
IOTP Transaction using a Related To Component (see section
3.3.3) in the Transaction Reference Block.
o if the Authentication transaction is successful, then the
original IOTP Transaction is restarted
o if the Authentication fails then the original IOTP Transaction
is cancelled.
For example, a Consumer could:
o authenticate the Payment Handler for a Payment between
receiving an Offer Response from a Merchant and before sending
the Payment Request to that Payment Handler
o authenticate a Delivery Handler for a Delivery between
receiving the Payment Response from a Payment Handler and
before sending the Delivery Request
A Payment Handler could authenticate a Consumer after receiving the
Payment Request and before sending the next Payment related message.
A Delivery Handler could authenticate a Consumer after receiving the
Delivery Request and before sending the Delivery Response.
[Note] Some Payment Methods may carry out an authentication within
the Payment Exchange. In this case the information required
to carry out the authentication will be included in Payment
Scheme Components.
In this instance IOTP aware application will not be aware
that an authentication has occurred since the Payment Scheme
Components that contain authentication data will be
indistinguishable from other Payment Scheme Components.
[Note End]
8.2 Infrastructure Transactions
Infrastructure Transactions are designed to support inquiries on
whether or not a transaction has succeeded or a Trading Role's servers
are operating correctly. There are two types of transaction:
David Burdett et al. [Page 253]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a Transaction Status Inquiry Transaction which provides
information on the status of an existing or complete IOTP
transaction, and
o Ping Transaction that enables one IOTP aware application to
determine if the IOTP aware application at another Trading Role
is operating and verify whether or not signatures can be
handled.
Each of these is described below
8.2.1 Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry IOTP Transaction
The Baseline IOTP Transaction Status Inquiry provides information on
the status of an existing or complete IOTP transaction.
The Trading Blocks used by the Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry
Transaction are:
o an Inquiry Request Trading Block (see section 7.12), and
o an Inquiry Response Trading Block (see section 7.13).
[Note] Note that:
o Consumer Inquiries on Authentication transaction are not
supported.
o Authentication of Consumers as part of an inquiry is not
supported in the Baseline version of IOTP.
[Note End]
WHICH TRADING ROLES CAN RECEIVE INQUIRY REQUESTS
The Consumer can send a Transaction Status Inquiry Block to the
appropriate Trading Role after the following events have occurred:
o to the Merchant, after sending TPO Selection Block,
o to the Payment Handler, after sending Payment Request Block,
o to the Delivery Handler, after sending Delivery Request Block.
[Note] IOTP does not support sending Inquiry Requests to the
Consumer since the consumer may not be on-line to receive
and process them.
David Burdett et al. [Page 254]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[Note End]
If the Consumer is inquiring on transaction that is not yet complete,
it should send the Inquiry Request Block to the Trading Role to which
it sent the last IOTP message. If the Consumer is inquiring on a
transaction which is complete, there are two alternatives in deciding
the Trading Roles that the Inquiry Request Block should be sent to:
o the Consumer IOTP software can ask the end user to determine
the type of inquiry they want to make, or
o the Consumer IOTP software can send the inquiry request message
to all the Trading Roles that were involved in the IOTP
transaction.
For the second case above, how the Consumer IOTP Aware Application
displays the inquiry response data received from each Trading Role is
up to each implementation.
TRANSACTION STATUS INQUIRY TRANSPORT SESSION
For a Transaction Status Inquiry on an ongoing transaction, the
Consumer shall establish with a Trading Role, a different transport
session from the ongoing transaction. For a Transaction Status Inquiry
on a past transaction, how the IOTP module on the software at the
Trading Role is started upon the receipt of Inquiry Request message is
defined in each Mapping to Transport supplement for IOTP.
TRANSACTION STATUS INQUIRY ERROR HANDLING
Errors in a Transaction Status Inquiry can be categorised into one the
following three cases:
o Business errors (see section 4.2) in the original (inquired)
messages
o Technical errors (see section 4.1) - both IOTP and payment
scheme specific ones - in the original IOTP (inquired) messages
o Technical errors in the message containing the Inquiry Request
Block itself
The following outlines what the software should do in each case
David Burdett et al. [Page 255]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
BUSINESS ERRORS IN THE ORIGINAL MESSAGES
Return an Inquiry Response Block containing the Status Component which
was last sent to the Consumer.
TECHNICAL ERRORS IN THE ORIGINAL MESSAGES
Return an Inquiry Response Block containing a Status Component. The
Status Component should contain a ProcessState attribute set to
ProcessError. In this case send back an Error Block indicating where
the error was found in the original message.
TECHNICAL ERRORS IN THE INQUIRY REQUEST BLOCK
Return an Error message. That is, send back an Error Block containing
the Error Code (see section 6.19.2) which describes the nature of the
error in the Inquiry Request message.
David Burdett et al. [Page 256]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
INQUIRY TRANSACTION MESSAGES
The following Figure outlines the Baseline IOTP Transaction Status
Inquiry processes on both Consumer and Service Provider sides.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
CONSUMER IOTP MESSAGE TRADING ROLE
1. The Consumer decides to inquire (Merchant,
on an IOTP transaction by, for Payment Handler,
example, clicking the inquiry button Delivery Handler
of the IOTP Aware Application. This or Financial
will then generate an Inquiry Institution)
Request Block and send it to the
appropriate Trading Role.
|
v
IotpMsg: Trans Ref 2. The Trading Role checks the
Block; Inquiry ----------> transaction status of the transaction
Request Block Inquiry that is being inquired upon by using
Request the Transaction Id Component of the
Transaction Reference Block. He then
generates the appropriate Inquiry
Response Block based on the status of
the transaction and sends the message
back to the Consumer
|
v
3. The IOTP Aware IotpMsg: Trans Ref
Application displays the <---------------- Block; Inquiry
status information to the Inquiry Response Response Block
end user
|
v
STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 34 Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry
The remainder of this sub-section on the Baseline Transaction Status
Inquiry IOTP Transaction defines the contents of each Trading Block.
David Burdett et al. [Page 257]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
TRANSACTION REFERENCE BLOCK
The Consumer must use the same Transaction Id Component (see section
3.3.1) as in the inquired transaction. The OtpTransId attribute in
this component serves as the key in querying the transaction logs
maintained at the Trading Role's site. The value of the ID attribute
of the Message Id Component should be different from those of the
inquired transaction (see section 3.4.1).
INQUIRY REQUEST BLOCK
The Inquiry Request Block (see section 7.12) contains the following
components:
o one Inquiry Type Component (see section 6.16). This identifies
whether the inquiry is on an offer, payment, or delivery.
o zero or one Payment Scheme Component (see section 6.9). This is
for encapsulating payment scheme specific inquiry messages for
inquiries on payment.
INQUIRY RESPONSE BLOCK
The Inquiry Response Block (see section 7.13) contains the following
components:
o one Status Component (see section 6.14). This component hold
the status information on the inquired transaction,
o zero or one Payment Scheme Components. These contain for
encapsulated payment scheme specific inquiry messages for
inquiries on payment.
8.2.2 Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction
The purpose of the Baseline IOTP Ping Transaction is to enable IOTP
aware application software to determine if the IOTP aware application
at another Trading Role is operating and verifying whether or not
signatures can be handled.
The Trading Blocks used by the Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction are:
o a Ping Request Block (see section 7.14)
o a Ping Response Block (see section 7.15), and
David Burdett et al. [Page 258]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a Signature Block (see section 7.16).
PING MESSAGES
The following figure outlines the message flows in the Baseline IOTP
Ping Transaction.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+**+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
IOTP TRADING ROLE IOTP MESSAGE IOTP TRADING ROLE
1. The IOTP Aware Application in an
IOTP Trading Role decides to check
whether the counterparty IOTP
application is up and running. It
generates a Ping Block and optional
Signature Block and sends them to
the other IOTP Trading Role.
|
v
IotpMsg: Trans Ref --------> 2. The IOTP Trading Role which receives
Block; Ping Ping the Ping Request generates a Ping
Request Block Request Response and sends it back to the
sender of the original Ping Request.
|
v
3. The original sender of the IotpMsg: Trans Ref
Ping Request checks the returned <------------ Block; Ping
Ping Response and takes Ping Response Response Block
appropriate action, if necessary
|
v
STOP
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
Figure 35 Baseline Ping Messages
The verification that signatures can be handled is indicated by the
sender of the Ping Request Block including:
o Organisation Components that identify itself and the intended
recipient of the Ping Request Block, and
o a Signature Block that signs data in the Ping Request.
In this way the receiver of the Ping Request:
David Burdett et al. [Page 259]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o knows who is sending the Ping Request and can therefore verify
the Signature on the Request, and
o knows who to generate a signature for on the Ping Response.
Note that a Ping Request:
o does not affect any on-going transaction
o does NOT start an IOTP aware application, unlike other IOTP
transaction messages such as TPO or Transaction Status Inquiry.
All IOTP aware applications must return a Ping Response message to the
sender of a Ping Request message when it is received.
A Baseline IOTP Ping request can also contain an optional Signature
Block. IOTP aware applications can, for example, use the Signature
Block to check the recipient of a Ping Request can successfully
process and check signatures it has received.
For each Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction, each IOTP role shall
establish a different transport session from other IOTP transactions.
Any IOTP Trading Role can send a Ping request to any other IOTP
Trading Role at any time it wants. A Ping message has its own
OtpTransId, which is different from other IOTP transactions.
The remainder of this sub-section on the Baseline Ping IOTP
Transaction defines the contents of each Trading Block.
TRANSACTION REFERENCE BLOCK
The OtpTransId of a Ping transaction should be different from any
other IOTP transaction.
PING REQUEST BLOCK
If the Ping Transaction is anonymous then no Organisation Components
are included in the Ping Request Block (see section 7.7).
If the Ping Transaction is not anonymous then the Ping Request Block
contains Organisation Components for:
o the sender of the Ping Request Block, and
o the verifier of the Signature Component
David Burdett et al. [Page 260]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
If Organisation Components are present, then it indicates that the
sender of the Ping Request message has generated a Signature Block.
The signature block must be verified by the Trading Role that receives
the Ping Request Block.
SIGNATURE BLOCK (PING REQUEST)
The Ping Request Signature Block (see section 7.16) contains the
following components:
o one Signature Component (see section 6.17)
o one or more Certificate Components, if required.
PING RESPONSE BLOCK
The Ping Response Block (see section 7.15) contains the following
component:
o the Organisation Component of the sender of the Ping Response
message
If the Ping Transaction is not anonymous then the Ping Response
additionally contains:
o copies of the Organisation Components contained in the Ping
Request Block.
SIGNATURE BLOCK (PING RESPONSE)
The Ping Response Signature Block (see section 7.16) contains the
following components:
o one Signature Component (see section 6.17)
o one or more Certificate Components, if required.
David Burdett et al. [Page 261]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
9. Retrieving Logos
This section describes how to retrieve logos for display by IOTP aware
software using the Logo Net Locations attribute contained in the Brand
Element (see section 6.6.1) and the Organisation Component (see
section 6.5).
The full address of a logo is defined as follows:
Logo_address ::= Logo_net_location "/" Logo_size
Logo_color_depth ".GIF"
Where:
o Logo_net_location is obtained from the LogoNetLocn attribute in
the Brand Element (see section 6.6.1) or the Organisation
Component. Note that:
- the content of this attribute is dependent on the Transport
Mechanism (such as HTTP) that is used. See the Transport
Mechanism supplement,
- implementers should check that if the rightmost character of Logo
Net Location is set to right-slash "/" then another, right slash
should not be included when generating the Logo Address,
o Logo_size identifies the size of the logo,
o Logo_color_depth identifies the colour depth of the logo
o "GIF" indicates that the logos are in GIF format
Logo_size and Logo_color_depth are specified by the implementer of the
IOTP software that is retrieving the logo depending on the size and
colour that they want to use.
9.1 Logo Size
There are five standard sizes for logos. The sizes in pixels and the
corresponding values for Logo Size are given in the table below.
Size in Logo Size
Pixels Value
David Burdett et al. [Page 262]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
32 x 32 or exsmall
32 x 20
53 x 33 small
103 x 65 medium
180 x 114 large
263 x 166 exlarge
9.2 Logo Color Depth
There are three standard colour depths. The colour depth (including
bits per pixel) and the corresponding value for Logo_Color_Depth are
given in the table below.
Color Depth Logo Color
(bits per pixel) Depth Value
4 (16 colors) 4
8 (256 colors) nothing
24 (16 million colors) 24
Note that if Logo Color Depth is omitted then a logo with the default
colour depth of 256 colours will be retrieved.
9.3 Logo Net Location Examples
If Logo Net Location was set to "ftp://logos.xzpay.com", then:
o "ftp://logos.xzpay.com/medium.gif" would retrieve a medium size
256 colour logo
o "ftp://logos.xzpay.com/small4.gif" would retrieve a small size
16 colour logo
David Burdett et al. [Page 263]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[Note] Organisations which make logos available for use with IOTP
should always make available "small" and "medium" size logos
and use the GIF format.
[Note End]
David Burdett et al. [Page 264]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
10. Brand List Examples
This example contains three examples of the XML for a Brand List
Component. It covers:
o a simple credit card based example
o a credit card based brand list including promotional credit
card brands, and
o a complex electronic cash based brand list
Note that:
o brand lists can be as complex or as simple as required
o all example techniques described in this appendix can be
included in one brand list.
10.1 Simple Credit Card Based Example
This is a simple example involving:
o only major credit card payment brands
o a single price in a single currency
o a single payment handler, and
o a single payment protocol
David Burdett et al. [Page 265]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<BrandList ID='M1.2'
XML:Lang='us-en'
ShortDesc='Purchase book including s&h'
PayDirection='Debit' >
<Brand ID ='M1.30'
BrandId='MC'
BrandName='MasterCard'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.mastercard.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.33'>
</Brand>
<Brand ID ='M.31'
BrandId='Visa'
BrandName='Visa'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.visa.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.33'>
</Brand>
<Brand ID ='M1.32'
BrandId='Amex'
BrandName='American Express'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.amex.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs ='M1.33' >
</Brand >
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.33'
PayProtocolRef='M1.35'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.34'>
</ProtocolAmount>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.34'
Amount='10.95'
CurrCode='USD'/>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.35'
ProtocolId='SCCD1.0'
ProtocolName='Secure Channel Credit/Debit'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.merchant.com/etill/sccd1' >
</PayProtocol>
</BrandList>
10.2 Credit Card Brand List Including Promotional Brands
An example of a Credit Card based Brand List follows. It includes:
o two ordinary card association brands and two promotional credit
card brands. The promotional brands consist of one loyalty
based (British Airways MasterCard) which offers additional
David Burdett et al. [Page 266]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
loyalty points and one store based (Walmart) which offers a
discount on purchases over a certain amount
o two payment protocols:
- SET (Secure Electronic Transactions) see [SET], and
- SCCD (Secure Channel Credit Debit) see [SCCD].
David Burdett et al. [Page 267]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<BrandList ID='M1.2'
XML:Lang='us-en'
ShortDesc='Purchase ladies coat'
PayDirection='Debit' >
<Brand ID ='M1.3'
BrandId='MC'
BrandName='MasterCard'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.mastercard.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.7 M1.8'>
</Brand>
<Brand ID ='M1.4'
BrandId='Visa'
BrandName='Visa'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.visa.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.7 M1.8'>
</Brand>
<Brand ID ='M1.5'
BrandId='MC/BritishAirways'
BrandName='British Airways MasterCard'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.britishairways.co.uk'
BrandNarrative='Double air miles with British Airways
MasterCard'
ProtocolAmountRefs ='M1.7 M1.8' >
</Brand >
<Brand ID ='M1.6'
BrandId='Walmart'
BrandName='Walmart Store Card'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.walmart.com'
BrandNarrative='5% off with your Walmart Card
on purchases over $150'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.7'>
</Brand>
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.7'
PayProtocolRef='M1.10'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.9' >
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
238djqw1298erh18dhoire
<PackagedContent>
</ProtocolAmount>
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.8'
PayProtocolRef='M1.11'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.9' >
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
238djqw1298erh18dhoire
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
</ProtocolAmount>
David Burdett et al. [Page 268]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.9'
Amount='157.53'
CurrCode='USD'/>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.10'
ProtocolId='SET1.0'
ProtocolName='Secure Electronic Transaction Version 1.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.merchant.com/etill/set1' >
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
8ueu26e482hd82he82
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
</PayProtocol>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.11'
ProtocolId='SCCD1.0'
ProtocolName='Secure Channel Credit/Debit'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.merchant.com/etill/sccd1' >
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
82hd82he8226e48ueu
<PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
</PayProtocol>
</BrandList>
10.3 Brand Selection Example
In order to pay by 'British Airways' MasterCard using the example
above using SET and therefore getting double air miles, the Brand
Selection would be:
<BrandSelection ID='C1.2'
BrandListRef='M1.3'
BrandRef='M1.5'
ProtocolAmountRef='M1.7'
CurrencyAmountRef='M1.9' >
</BrandSelection>
10.4 Complex Electronic Cash Based Brand List
The following is an fairly complex example which includes:
o payments using either Mondex, GeldKarte, CyberCash or DigiCash
o in currencies including US dollars, British Pounds, Italian
Lira, German Marks and Canadian Dollars
David Burdett et al. [Page 269]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o a discount on the price if the payment is made in Mondex using
British pounds or US dollars, and
o more than one payment handler is used for payments involving
Mondex or CyberCash
o support for more than one version of a CyberCash CyberCoin
payment protocol.
David Burdett et al. [Page 270]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<BrandList ID='M1.2'
XML:Lang='us-en'
ShortDesc='Company report on XYZ Co'
PayDirection='Debit' >
<Brand ID ='M1.13'
BrandId='MX'
BrandName='Mondex Electronic Cash'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.mondex.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.17 M1.18'>
</Brand>
<Brand ID ='M1.14'
BrandId='GK'
BrandName='GeldKarte Electronic Cash'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.geldkarte.co.de'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.19'>
</Brand>
<Brand ID ='M1.15'
BrandId='CCash'
BrandName='CyberCoin Eletronic Cash'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.cybercash.com'
ProtocolAmountRefs ='M1.20' >
</Brand >
<Brand ID ='M1.16'
BrandId='DigiCash'
BrandName='DigiCash Electronic Cash'
BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp:otplogos.digicash.com'
BrandNarrative='5% off with your Walmart Card
on purchases over $150'
ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.22'>
</Brand>
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.17'
PayProtocolRef='M1.31'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.25 M1.29'>
</ProtocolAmount>
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.18'
PayProtocolRef='M1.32'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.26 M1.27 M1.28 M1.30'>
</ProtocolAmount>
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.19'
PayProtocolRef='M1.35'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.28'>
</ProtocolAmount>
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.20'
PayProtocolRef='M1.34 M1.33'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.23 M1.24 M1.27 M1.28 M1.29 M1.30'>
</ProtocolAmount>
David Burdett et al. [Page 271]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.21'
PayProtocolRef='M1.36'
CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.23 M1.24 M1.27 M1.28 M1.29 M1.30'>
</ProtocolAmount>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.23'
Amount='20.00'
CurrCode='USD'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.24'
Amount='12.00'
CurrCode='GBP'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.25'
Amount='19.50'
CurrCode='USD'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.26'
Amount='11.75'
CurrCode='GBP'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.27'
Amount='36.00'
CurrCode='DEM'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.28'
Amount='100.00'
CurrCode='FFR'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.29'
Amount='22.00'
CurrCode='CAD'/>
<CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.30'
Amount='15000'
CurrCode='ITL'/>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.31'
ProtocolId='MXv1.0'
ProtocolName='Mondex IOTP Protocol Version 1.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.mxbankus.com/etill/mx' >
</PayProtocol>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.32'
ProtocolId='MXv1.0'
ProtocolName='Mondex IOTP Protocol Version 1.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.mxbankuk.com/vserver' >
</PayProtocol>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.33'
ProtocolId='Ccashv1.0'
ProtocolName='CyberCash Version 1.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.ccash.com/ccoin' >
</PayProtocol>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.34'
ProtocolId='CCashv2.0'
ProtocolName='CyberCash Version 2.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.ccash.com/ccoin' >
David Burdett et al. [Page 272]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
</PayProtocol>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.35'
ProtocolId='GKv1.0'
ProtocolName='GeldKarte Version 1.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.merchant.com/pgway' >
</PayProtocol>
<PayProtocol ID ='M1.36'
ProtocolId='DCashv1.0'
ProtocolName='DigiCash Protocol Version 1.0'
PayReqNetLocn='http://www.merchant.com/digicash' >
</PayProtocol>
</BrandList>
David Burdett et al. [Page 273]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
11. Open Trading Protocol Data Type Definition
This section contains the XML DTD for the Internet Open Trading
Protocols.
David Burdett et al. [Page 274]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!--
******************************************************
* *
* OPEN TRADING PROTOCOL DTD VERSION 1.0.1 *
* *
* Changes from version 1.0 *
* - Added xmlns namespace attribute to OtpMessage *
* element *
* - Added SenderTradingRoleRef to MsgId Component *
* - Added Name attribute to PackagedContent element *
* - Changed usage of PackagedContent in following *
* elements to support multiple PackagedContent *
* occurences: AuthData, AuthResp, Order, Brand, *
* ProtocolAmount, PayProtocol, BrandSelBrandInfo, *
* BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo, *
* BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo, PaySchemeData, *
* PayReceipt, PaymentNote, Delivery, DeliveryData, *
* DeliveryNote and TradingRoleData. *
* - Changed the REQUIRED to IMPLIED on the *
* SenderNetLocn and SecureSenderNetLoc attributes *
* of the ProtocolOptions component *
* - Changed TradingRole element by: adding Id *
* attribute, changing CancelNetLocn and ErrorLocn *
* attributes to Required from Implied, adding *
* ErrorLogNetLocn attribute *
* - Removed PackagedContent from Payment Component *
* - Removed the AuthDataRef attribute from the *
* Payment Component *
* - Changed PayReceiptRefs attribute of the Payment *
* Receipt component to Implied from Required *
* - Changed the permitted values of StatusType *
* attribute in the Status Component and Type *
* attribute in the Inquiry Type Component to be *
* NMTOKEN to allow extra Status types to be defined*
* - Removed AuthData Component from the Offer *
* Response Block *
* - Removed Org Component from the AuthReq Block *
* - Removed Status Component from the AuthResp Block *
* - Added an AuthStatusBlk Block *
* - Removed AuthData component from PayReqBlk *
* - Added a CancelBlk Block *
* - Added Status Component to the Payment Instrument *
* Customer Care Response Block *
* - A number of layout changes to improve appearance *
* - Removed references to payment instrument customer*
* care. Specifically: removed PayInstCCExchBlk, *
David Burdett et al. [Page 275]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
* PayInstCCReqBlk, PayInstCCRespBlk, and *
* PayMethodInfo and reference to these *
* - Removed OtpSig and OtpCert components and *
* replaced with Signatures and Certificate *
* components based on DSIG proposal *
* - Added Algorithm Element to AuthData Block *
* - Removed AuthMethod and added AlgorithmRefs *
* attribute to AuthData Block *
* - Added SelectedAlgorithmRef attribute to *
* AuthResp Block *
* *
* Copyright Internet Engineering Task Force 1998,99 *
* *
******************************************************
******************************************************
* OTP MESSAGE DEFINITION *
******************************************************
-->
<!ELEMENT OtpMessage
( TransRefBlk,
SigBlk?,
ErrorBlk?,
( AuthReqBlk |
AuthRespBlk |
AuthStatusBlk |
CancelBlk |
DeliveryReqBlk |
DeliveryRespBlk |
InquiryReqBlk |
InquiryRespBlk |
OfferRespBlk |
PayExchBlk |
PayReqBlk |
PayRespBlk |
PingReqBlk |
PingRespBlk |
TpoBlk |
TpoSelectionBlk
)*
) >
<!ATTLIST OtpMessage
xmlns:iotp CDATA
'ietf.org/draft-ietf-trade-iotp-v1.0-protocol-03' >
David Burdett et al. [Page 276]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!--
******************************************************
* TRANSACTION REFERENCE BLOCK DEFINITION *
******************************************************
-->
<!ELEMENT TransRefBlk (TransId, MsgId, RelatedTo*) >
<!ATTLIST TransRefBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT TransId EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST TransId
ID ID #REQUIRED
Version NMTOKEN #FIXED '1.0'
OtpTransId NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OtpTransType CDATA #REQUIRED
TransTimeStamp CDATA #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT MsgId EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST MsgId
ID ID #REQUIRED
RespOtpMsg NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
SenderTradingRoleRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
SoftwareId CDATA #REQUIRED
TimeStamp CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT RelatedTo (PackagedContent) >
<!ATTLIST RelatedTo
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
RelationshipType NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
Relation CDATA #REQUIRED
RelnKeyWords NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >
<!--
******************************************************
* Packaged Content Common Element *
******************************************************
-->
David Burdett et al. [Page 277]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT PackagedContent (#PCDATA) >
<!ATTLIST PackagedContent
Name NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Content NMTOKEN "PCDATA"
Transform (NONE|BASE64) "NONE" >
<!--
******************************************************
* TRADING COMPONENTS *
******************************************************
-->
<!-- PROTOCOL OPTIONS COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT ProtocolOptions EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST ProtocolOptions
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
SenderNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
SecureSenderNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
SuccessNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED >
<!-- AUTHENTICATION DATA COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT AuthData (PackagedContent+, Algorithm+)>
<!ATTLIST AuthData
ID ID #REQUIRED
AuthenticationId CDATA #REQUIRED
TradingRoleList NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AlgorithmRefs IDREFS #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT AuthResp (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST AuthResp
ID ID #REQUIRED
SelectedAlgorithmRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- ORDER COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT Order (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST Order
ID ID #REQUIRED
David Burdett et al. [Page 278]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrderIdentifier CDATA #REQUIRED
ShortDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
OkFrom CDATA #REQUIRED
OkTo CDATA #REQUIRED
ApplicableLaw CDATA #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- ORGANISATION COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT Org (TradingRole+, ContactInfo?,
PersonName?, PostalAddress?)>
<!ATTLIST Org
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrgId CDATA #REQUIRED
OtpMsgIdPrefix NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
LegalName CDATA #IMPLIED
ShortDesc CDATA #IMPLIED
LogoNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT TradingRole EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST TradingRole
ID ID #REQUIRED
TradingRole NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CancelNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
ErrorNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
ErrorLogNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT ContactInfo EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST ContactInfo
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Tel CDATA #IMPLIED
Fax CDATA #IMPLIED
Email CDATA #IMPLIED
NetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT PersonName EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST PersonName
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Title CDATA #IMPLIED
GivenName CDATA #IMPLIED
Initials CDATA #IMPLIED
FamilyName CDATA #IMPLIED >
David Burdett et al. [Page 279]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT PostalAddress EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST PostalAddress
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AddressLine1 CDATA #IMPLIED
AddressLine2 CDATA #IMPLIED
CityOrTown CDATA #IMPLIED
StateOrRegion CDATA #IMPLIED
PostalCode CDATA #IMPLIED
Country CDATA #IMPLIED
LegalLocation (True | False) 'False' >
<!-- BRAND LIST COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT BrandList (Brand+, ProtocolAmount+,
CurrencyAmount+, PayProtocol+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandList
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
PayDirection (Debit | Credit) #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Brand (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST Brand
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
BrandId NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BrandName CDATA #REQUIRED
BrandLogoNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
BrandNarrative CDATA #IMPLIED
ProtocolAmountRefs IDREFS #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT ProtocolAmount (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST ProtocolAmount
ID ID #REQUIRED
PayProtocolRef IDREF #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRefs IDREFS #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT CurrencyAmount EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST CurrencyAmount
ID ID #REQUIRED
Amount CDATA #REQUIRED
CurrCodeType NMTOKEN 'ISO4217'
CurrCode CDATA #REQUIRED >
David Burdett et al. [Page 280]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT PayProtocol (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST PayProtocol
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProtocolId NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolName CDATA #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReqNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
SecPayReqNetLocn CDATA #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- BRAND SELECTION COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT BrandSelection (BrandSelBrandInfo?,
BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo?,
BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo?) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelection
ID ID #REQUIRED
BrandListRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BrandRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolAmountRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT BrandSelBrandInfo (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelBrandInfo
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- PAYMENT COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT Payment EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST Payment
ID ID #REQUIRED
OkFrom CDATA #REQUIRED
OkTo CDATA #REQUIRED
BrandListRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
David Burdett et al. [Page 281]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
SignedPayReceipt (True | False) #REQUIRED
StartAfter NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >
<!-- PAYMENT SCHEME COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT PaySchemeData (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST PaySchemeData
ID ID #REQUIRED
ConsumerPaymentId CDATA #IMPLIED
PaymentHandlerPayId CDATA #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- PAYMENT RECEIPT COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT PayReceipt (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST PayReceipt
ID ID #REQUIRED
PaymentRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReceiptRefs NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- PAYMENT NOTE COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT PaymentNote (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST PaymentNote
ID ID #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- DELIVERY COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT Delivery (DeliveryData?, PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST Delivery
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivExch (True | False) #REQUIRED
DelivAndPayResp (True | False) #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ConsumerDeliveryId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT DeliveryData (PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryData
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
OkFrom CDATA #REQUIRED
OkTo CDATA #REQUIRED
DelivMethod NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivToRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivReqNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
David Burdett et al. [Page 282]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
SecDelivReqNetLocn CDATA #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- DELIVERY NOTE COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT DeliveryNote (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryNote
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivHandlerDelivId CDATA #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- STATUS COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT Status EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST Status
ID ID #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
StatusType NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProcessState (NotYetStarted | InProgress |
CompletedOk | Failed | ProcessError) #REQUIRED
CompletionCode NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference CDATA #IMPLIED
StatusDesc CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- TRADING ROLE DATA COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT TradingRoleData (PackagedContent+) >
<!ATTLIST TradingRoleData
ID ID #REQUIRED
OriginatorElRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DestinationElRefs NMTOKENS #REQUIRED >
<!-- INQUIRY TYPE COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT InquiryType EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST InquiryType
ID ID #REQUIRED
Type NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!-- ERROR COMPONENT -->
<!ELEMENT ErrorComp (ErrorLocation+, PackagedContent*) >
<!ATTLIST ErrorComp
ID NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
David Burdett et al. [Page 283]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
ErrorCode NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorDesc CDATA #REQUIRED
Severity (Warning|TransientError|HardError) #REQUIRED
MinRetrySecs CDATA #IMPLIED
SwVendorErrorRef CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT ErrorLocation EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST ErrorLocation
ElementType NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OtpMsgRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BlkRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
CompRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ElementRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AttName NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >
<!--
******************************************************
* TRADING BLOCKS *
******************************************************
-->
<!-- TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT TpoBlk ( ProtocolOptions, BrandList*, Org* ) >
<!ATTLIST TpoBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- TPO SELECTION BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT TpoSelectionBlk (BrandSelection+) >
<!ATTLIST TpoSelectionBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT OfferRespBlk (Status, Order?, Payment*,
Delivery?, TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST OfferRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- AUTHENTICATION REQUEST BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT AuthReqBlk (AuthData?) >
<!ATTLIST AuthReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
David Burdett et al. [Page 284]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!-- AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT AuthRespBlk (AuthResp, Org*) >
<!ATTLIST AuthRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- AUTHENTICATION STATUS BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT AuthStatusBlk (Status) >
<!ATTLIST AuthStatusBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- PAYMENT REQUEST BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT PayReqBlk (Status+, BrandList, BrandSelection,
Payment, PaySchemeData?, Org*, TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST PayReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- PAYMENT EXCHANGE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT PayExchBlk (PaySchemeData) >
<!ATTLIST PayExchBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- PAYMENT RESPONSE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT PayRespBlk (Status, PayReceipt, PaySchemeData?,
PaymentNote?, TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST PayRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- DELIVERY REQUEST BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT DeliveryReqBlk (Status+, Order, Org*, Delivery,
TradingRoleData*) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- DELIVERY RESPONSE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT DeliveryRespBlk (Status, DeliveryNote) >
<!ATTLIST DeliveryRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- INQUIRY REQUEST BLOCK -->
David Burdett et al. [Page 285]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT InquiryReqBlk ( InquiryType, PaySchemeData? ) >
<!ATTLIST InquiryReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- INQUIRY RESPONSE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT InquiryRespBlk (Status, PaySchemeData?) >
<!ATTLIST InquiryRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED
LastReceivedOtpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
LastSentOtpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >
<!-- PING REQUEST BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT PingReqBlk (Org*)>
<!ATTLIST PingReqBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED>
<!-- PING RESPONSE BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT PingRespBlk (Org+)>
<!ATTLIST PingRespBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED
PingStatusCode (Ok | Busy | Down) #REQUIRED
SigVerifyStatusCode (Ok | NotSupported | Fail) #IMPLIED
xml:lang NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
PingStatusDesc CDATA #IMPLIED>
<!-- ERROR BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT ErrorBlk (ErrorComp+, PaySchemeData*) >
<!ATTLIST ErrorBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!-- CANCEL BLOCK -->
<!ELEMENT CancelBlk (Status) >
<!ATTLIST CancelBlk
ID ID #REQUIRED >
<!--
******************************************************
* IOTP SIGNATURES BLOCK DEFINITION *
******************************************************
-->
David Burdett et al. [Page 286]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT IOTPSignatures (Signature+, Certificate*) >
<!ATTLIST IOTPSignatures
ID ID #IMPLIED >
<!--
******************************************************
* IOTP SIGNAUTRE COMPPONENT DEFINITION *
******************************************************
-->
<!ELEMENT Signature (Manifest, Value+) >
<!ATTLIST Signature
ID ID #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT Manifest
(Algorithm+,
Digest+,
Attributes?,
OriginatorInfo,
RecipientInfo+,
)
<!ATTLIST Manifest
LocatorHRefBase CDATA #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT Algorithm (Parameter*) >
<!ATTRLIST Algorithm
ID ID #REQUIRED
type (digest|signature|keyagreement) #IMPLIED
name NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Digest (Value) >
<!ATTLIST Digest
LocatorHREF NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DigestAlgorithmRef IDREF #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Attributes (Attribute+) >
<!ELEMENT Attribute ( #PCDATA ) >
<!ATTLIST Attribute
type NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
critical ( true | false ) #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT OriginatorInfo ANY >
<!ATTLIST OriginatorInfo
OriginatorRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >
David Burdett et al. [Page 287]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
<!ELEMENT RecipientInfo ANY >
<!ATTLIST RecipientInfo
SignatureAlgorithmRef IDREF #REQUIRED
SignatureValueRef IDREF #REQUIRED
SignatureCertRef IDREF #IMPLIED
RecipientRefs NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >
<!ELEMENT Parameter ANY >
<!ATTLIST Parameter
type PCDATA #REQUIRED >
<!--
******************************************************
* IOTP CERTIFICATE COMPPONENT DEFINITION *
******************************************************
-->
<!ELEMENT Certificate (
IssuerAndSerialNumber
( Value | Locator ) )>
<!ATTLIST Certificate
ID ID #IMPLIED
type NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT IssuerAndSerialNumber EMPTY >
<!ATTLIST IssuerAndSerialNumber
issuer CDATA #REQUIRED
number CDATA #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Value ( #PCDATA ) >
<!ATTLIST Value
id ID #IMPLIED
encoding ( base64 | none ) #REQUIRED >
<!ELEMENT Locator EMPTY>
<!ATTLIST Locator
href CDATA #REQUIRED >
David Burdett et al. [Page 288]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
12. Glossary
This section contains a glossary of some of the terms used within this
specification in alphabetical order.
NAME DESCRIPTION
Authenticator The Organisation which is requesting the
authentication of another Organisation, and
Authenticatee The Organisation being authenticated by an
Authenticator
Business Error See Status Component.
Brand A Brand is the mark which identifies a
particular type of Payment Instrument. A list of
Brands are the payment options which are
presented by the Merchant to the Consumer and
from which the Consumer makes a selection. Each
Brand may have a different Payment Handler.
Examples of Brands include:
o payment association and proprietary Brands,
for example MasterCard, Visa, American
Express, Diners Club, American Express,
Mondex, GeldKarte, CyberCash, etc.
o Promotional Brands (see below). These include:
o store Brands, where the Payment Instrument is
issued to a Consumer by a particular Merchant,
for example Walmart, Sears, or Marks and
Spencer (UK)
o coBrands, for example American Advantage Visa,
where an a company uses their own Brand in
conjunction with, typically, a payment
association Brand.
Consumer The Organisation which is to receive the benefit
of and typically pay for the goods or services.
Customer Care An Organisation that is providing customer care
Provider typically on behalf of a Merchant. Examples of
customer care include, responding to problems
raised by a Consumer arising from an IOTP
Transaction that the Consumer took part in.
David Burdett et al. [Page 289]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Delivery Handler The Organisation that physically delivers the
goods or services to the Consumer on behalf of
the Merchant.
Dual Brand A Dual Brand means that a single Payment
Instrument may be used as if it were two
separate Brands. For example there could be a
single Japanese "UC" MasterCard which can be
used as either a UC card or a regular
MasterCard. The UC card Brand and the MasterCard
Brand could each have their own separate Payment
Handlers. This means that:
o the Merchant treats, for example "UC" and
"MasterCard" as two separate Brands when
offering a list of Brands to the Consumer,
o the Consumer chooses a Brand, for example
either "UC" or "MasterCard,
o the Consumer IOTP aware application determines
which Payment Instrument(s) match the chosen
Brand, and selects, perhaps with user
assistance, the correct Payment Instrument to
use.
Exchange Block An Exchange Block is sent between the two
Trading Roles involved in a Trading Exchange. It
contains one or more Trading Components.
Exchange Blocks are always sent after a Request
Block and before a Response Block in a Trading
Exchange. The content of an Exchange Block is
dependent on the type of Trading Exchange being
carried out.
Error Block An Error Block reports that a Technical Error
was found in an IOTP Message that was previously
received. Typically Technical Errors are caused
by errors in the XML which has been received or
some technical failure of the processing of the
IOTP Message. Frequently the generation or
receipt of an Error Block will result in failure
of the IOTP Transaction. They are distinct from
Business Errors, reported in a Status Component,
which can also cause failure of an IOTP
Transaction.
David Burdett et al. [Page 290]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
IOTP Message An IOTP Message is the outermost wrapper for the
document(s) which are sent between Trading Roles
that are taking part in a trade. It is a well
formed XML document. The documents it contains
consist of:
o a Transaction Reference Block to uniquely
identify the IOTP Transaction of which the
IOTP Message is part,
o an optional Signature Block to digitally sign
the Trading Blocks or Trading Components
associated with the IOTP Transaction
o an optional Error Block to report on technical
errors contained in a previously received IOTP
Message, and
o a collection of IOTP Trading Blocks which
carries the data required to carry out an IOTP
Transaction.
IOTP Transaction An instance of an Internet Open Trading Protocol
Transaction consists of a set of IOTP Messages
transferred between Trading Roles. The rules for
what may be contained in the IOTP Messages is
defined by the Transaction Type of IOTP
Transaction.
Document Exchange A Document Exchange consists of a set of IOTP
Messages exchanged between two parties that
implement part or all of two Trading Exchanges
simultaneously in order to minimise the number
of actual OTP Messages which must be sent over
the Internet.
Document Exchanges are combined together in
sequence to implement a particular IOTP
Transaction.
Merchant The Organisation from whom the service or goods
are being obtained, who is legally responsible
for providing the goods or services and receives
the benefit of any payment made
Merchant Customer The Organisation that is involved with customer
Care Provider dispute negotiation and resolution on behalf of
the Merchant
David Burdett et al. [Page 291]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Organisation A company or individual that takes part in a
Trade as a Trading Role. The organisations may
take one or more of the roles involved in the
Trade
Payment Handler The Organisation that physically receives the
payment from the Consumer on behalf of the
Merchant
Payment Instrument A Payment Instrument is the means by which
Consumer pays for goods or services offered by a
Merchant. It can be, for example:
o a credit card such as MasterCard or Visa;
o a debit card such as MasterCard's Maestro;
o a smart card based electronic cash Payment
Instrument such as a Mondex Card, a GeldKarte
card or a Visa Cash card
o a software based electronic payment account
such as a CyberCash or DigiCash account.
All Payment Instruments have a number, typically
an account number, by which the Payment
Instrument can be identified.
David Burdett et al. [Page 292]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Promotional Brand A Promotional Brand means that, if the Consumer
pays with that Brand, then the Consumer will
receive some additional benefit which can be
received in two ways:
o at the time of purchase. For example if a
Consumer pays with a "Walmart MasterCard" at a
Walmart web site, then a 5% discount might
apply, which means the Consumer actually pays
less,
o from their Payment Instrument (card) issuer
when the payment appears on their statement.
For example loyalty points in a frequent flyer
scheme could be awarded based on the total
payments made with the Payment Instrument
since the last statement was issued.
Each Promotional Brand should be identified as a
separate Brand in the list of Brands offered by
the Merchant. For example: "Walmart", "Sears",
"Marks and Spencer" and "American Advantage
Visa", would each be a separate Brand.
Receipt Component A Receipt Component is a record of the
successful completion of a Trading Exchange.
Examples of Receipt Components include: Payment
Receipts, and Delivery Notes. It's content may
dependent on the technology used to perform the
Trading Exchange. For example a Secure
Electronic Transaction (SET) payment receipt
consists of SET payment messages which record
the result of the payment.
David Burdett et al. [Page 293]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Request Block A Request Block is Trading Block that contains a
request for a Trading Exchange to start. The
Trading Components in a Request Block may be
signed by a Signature Block so that their
authenticity may be checked and to determine
that the Trading Exchange being requested is
authorised. Authorisation for a Trading Exchange
to start can be provided by the signatures
contained on Receipt Components contained in
Response Blocks resulting from previously
completed Trading Exchanges. Examples of
Request Blocks are Payment Request and Delivery
Request
Response Block A Response Block is a Trading Block that
indicates that a Trading Exchange is complete.
It is sent by the Trading Role that received a
Request Block to the Trading Role that sent the
Request Block. The Response Block contains a
Status Component that contains information about
the completion of the Trading Exchange, for
example it indicates whether or not the Trading
Exchange completed successfully. For some
Trading Exchanges the Response Block contains a
Receipt Component that forms a record of the
Trading Exchange. Receipt Components may be
digitally signed using a Signature Block to make
completion non-refutable. Examples of Response
Blocks include Offer Response, Payment Response
and Delivery Response.
Signature Block A Signature Block is a Trading Block that
contains one or more digital signatures in the
form of Signature Components. A Signature
Component may digitally sign any Block or
Component in any IOTP Message in the same IOTP
Transaction.
David Burdett et al. [Page 294]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Status Component A Status Component contains information that
describes the state of a Trading Exchange.
Before the Trading Exchange is complete the
Status Component can indicate information about
how the Trading Exchange is progressing.
Once a Trading Exchange is complete the Status
Component can only indicate the success of the
Trading Exchange or that a Business Error has
occurred.
A Business Error indicates that continuation
with the Trading Exchange was not possible
because of some business rule or logic, for
example, "insufficient funds available", rather
than any Technical Error associated with the
content or format of the IOTP Messages in the
IOTP Transaction.
Technical Error See Error Block.
Trading Block A Trading Block consists of one or more Trading
Components. One or more Trading Blocks may be
contained within the IOTP Messages which are
physically sent in the form of [XML] documents
between the different Trading Roles that are
taking part in a trade. Trading Blocks are of
three main types:
o a Request Block,
o an Exchange Block, or a
o a Response Block
Trading Component A Trading Component is a collection of XML
elements and attributes. Trading Components are
the child elements of the Trading Blocks.
Examples of Trading Components are: Offer, Brand
List, Payment Receipt, Delivery [information],
Payment Amount [information]
David Burdett et al. [Page 295]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Trading Exchange A Trading Exchange consists of the exchange,
between two Trading Roles, of a sequence of
documents. The documents may be in the form of
Trading Blocks or they may be transferred by
some other means, for example through entering
data into a web page. Each Trading Exchange
consists of three main parts:
o the sending of a Request Block by one Trading
Role (the initiator) to another Trading Role
(the recipient),
o the optional exchange of one or more Exchange
Blocks between the recipient and the
initiator, until eventually,
o the Trading Role that received the Request
Block sends a Response Block to the initiator.
A Trading Exchange is designed to implement a
useful service of some kind. Examples of Trading
Exchanges/services are:
o Offer, which results in a Consumer receiving
an offer from a Merchant to carry out a
business transaction of some kind,
o Payment, where a Consumer makes a payment to a
Payment Handler,
o Delivery, where a Consumer requests, and
optionally obtains, delivery of goods or
services from a Delivery Handler, and
o Authentication, where any Trading Role may
request and receive information about another
Trading Role.
Transaction A Transaction Reference Block identifies an IOTP
Reference Block Transaction. It contains data that identifies:
o the Transaction Type,
o the IOTP Transaction uniquely, through a
globally unique transaction identifier
o the IOTP Message uniquely within the IOTP
Transaction, through a message identifier
The Transaction Reference Block may also contain
references to other transactions which may or
may not be IOTP Transactions
David Burdett et al. [Page 296]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
NAME DESCRIPTION
Trading Role A Trading Role identifies the different ways in
which organisations can participate in a trade.
There are five Trading Roles: Consumer,
Merchant, Payment Handler, Delivery Handler, and
Merchant Customer Care Provider.
Transaction Type A Transaction Type identifies the type an of
IOTP Transaction. Examples of Transaction Type
include: Purchase, Refund, Authentication,
Withdrawal, Deposit (of electronic cash). The
Transaction Type specifies for an IOTP
Transaction:
o the Trading Exchanges which may be included in
the transaction,
o how those Trading Exchanges may be combined to
meet the business needs of the transaction
o which Trading Blocks may be included in the
IOTP Messages that make up the transaction
o Consult this specification for the rules that
apply for each Transaction Type.
David Burdett et al. [Page 297]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
13. Copyrights
Copyright (C) The Internet Society (1998). All Rights Reserved.
This document and translations of it may be copied and furnished to
others, and derivative works that comment on or otherwise explain it
or assist in its implementation may be prepared, copied, published and
distributed, in whole or in part, without restriction of any kind,
provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph are
included on all such copies and derivative works. However, this
document itself may not be modified in any way, such as by removing
the copyright notice or references to the Internet Society or other
Internet organisations, except as needed for the purpose of developing
Internet standards in which case the procedures for copyrights defined
in the Internet Standards process must be followed, or as required to
translate it into languages other than English.
The limited permissions granted above are perpetual and will not be
revoked by the Internet Society or its successors or assigns.
This document and the information contained herein is provided on an
AS IS basis and THE INTERNET SOCIETY AND THE INTERNET ENGINEERING TASK
FORCE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTY THAT THE USE OF THE INFORMATION HEREIN WILL
NOT INFRINGE ANY RIGHTS OR ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
David Burdett et al. [Page 298]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
14. References
This section contains references to related documents identified in
this specification.
[Base64] Base64 Content-Transfer-Encoding. A method of
transporting binary data defined by MIME. See: RFC 2045:
Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions (MIME) Part One:
Format of Internet Message Bodies. N. Freed & N.
Borenstein. November 1996.
[DOM-HASH] A method for generating hashes of all or part of an XML
tree based on the DOM of that tree. See
<ftp://ftp.pothole.com/pub/dee3/drarft-hiroshi-com-hash-
00.txt>.
[DNS] The Internet Domain Name System which allocates Internet
names to organisations for example "OTP.org", the Domain
Name for IOTP. See RFC 1034: Domain names - concepts and
facilities. P.V. Mockapetris. Nov-01-1987, and RFC 1035:
Domain names - implementation and specification. P.V.
Mockapetris. Nov-01-1987.
[DSA] The Digital Signature Algorithm (DSA) published by the
National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) in
the Digital Signature Standard (DSS), which is a part of
the US government's Capstone project.
[ECCDSA] Elliptic Curve Cryptosystems Digital Signature Algorithm
(ECCDSA). Elliptic curve cryptosystems are analogues of
public-key cryptosystems such as RSA in which modular
multiplication is replaced by the elliptic curve
addition operation. See: V. S. Miller. Use of elliptic
curves in cryptography. In Advances in Cryptology -
Crypto '85, pages 417-426, Springer-Verlag, 1986.
[HMAC] See Message Authentication Using hash Functions: the
HMAC Construction. RSA Cryptobytes, Volume 2, Number 1,
Spring 1996
David Burdett et al. [Page 299]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[HTML] Hyper Text Mark Up Language. The Hypertext Mark-up
Language (HTML) is a simple mark-up language used to
create hypertext documents that are platform
independent. See RFC 1866 and the World Wide Web (W3C)
consortium web site at: http://www.w3.org/MarkUp/
[HTTP] Hyper Text Transfer Protocol versions 1.0 and 1.1. See
RFC 1945: Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0. T.
Berners-Lee, R. Fielding & H. Frystyk. May 1996. and RFC
2068: Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1. R.
Fielding, J. Gettys, J. Mogul, H. Frystyk, T. Berners-
Lee. January 1997.
[IANA] The Internet Assigned Numbers Authority. The
organisation responsible for co-ordinating the names and
numbers associated with the Internet. See
http://www.iana.org/.
[ISO4217] ISO 4217: Codes for the Representation of Currencies.
Available from ANSI or ISO.
[MD5] R.L. Rivest. RFC 1321: The MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm.
[MIME] Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions. See RFC822,
RFC2045, RFC2046, RFC2047, RFC2048 and RFC2049.
[OPS] Open Profiling Standard. A proposed standard which
provides a framework with built-in privacy safeguards
for the trusted exchange of profile information between
individuals and web sites. Being developed by Netscape
and Microsoft amongst others.
[RFC822] IETF (Internet Engineering Task Force). RFC 822: The
Standard for the Format of ARPA Internet Messages
. 13 August 1982, David H Crocker. 13 August 1982.
[RFC1738] IETF (Internet Engineering Task Force). RFC 1738:
Uniform Resource Locators (URL), ed. T. Berners-Lee, L.
Masinter, M. McCahill. 1994.
[RFC2434] IETF (Internet Engineering Task Force). RFC 2434.
Guidelines for Writing an IANA Considerations Section in
RFCs. T. Narten and H. Alvestrand
David Burdett et al. [Page 300]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[RSA] RSA is a public-key cryptosystem for both encryption and
authentication supported by RSA Data Security Inc. See:
R. L. Rivest, A. Shamir, and L.M. Adleman. A method for
obtaining digital signatures and public-key
cryptosystems. Communications of the ACM, 21(2): 120-
126, February 1978.
[SCCD] Secure Channel Credit Debit. A method of conducting a
credit or debit card payment where unauthorised access
to account information is prevented through use of
secure channel transport mechanisms such as SSL. An IOTP
supplement describing how SCCD works is under
development. Author. Jonathan Sowler JCP,
[SET] Secure Electronic Transaction Specification, Version
1.0, May 31, 1997. Supports credit and debit card
payments using certificates at the Consumer and Merchant
to help ensure authenticity.
Download from:
<http://www.mastercard.com/set/specs.html>.
[SHA1] [FIPS-180-1]"Secure Hash Standard", National Institute
of Standards and Technology, US Department Of Commerce,
April 1995. Also known as: 59 Fed Reg. 35317 (1994).
[UTC] Universal Time Co-ordinated. A method of defining time
absolutely relative to Greenwich Mean Time (GMT).
Typically of the form: "CCYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS.sssZ+n"
where the "+n" defines the number of hours from GMT. See
ISO DIS8601.
[UTF16] The Unicode Standard, Version 2.0. The Unicode
Consortium, Reading, Massachusetts. See ISO/IEC 10646 1
Proposed Draft Amendment 1
[X.509] ITU Recommendation X.509 1993 | ISO/IEC 9594-8: 1995,
Including Draft Amendment 1: Certificate Extensions
(Version 3 Certificate)
[XML Recommendation for Namespaces in XML, World Wide Web
Namespace] Consortium, 14 January 1999, "http://www.w3.org/TR/REC-
xml-names"
[XML] Extensible Mark Up Language. See
http://www.w3.org/TR/PR-xml-971208 for the 8 December
1997 version.
David Burdett et al. [Page 301]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
[XMLDSIG] A proposal developed by Richard Brown, GlobeSet
describing an approach to signing XML documents such as
IOTP Messages. See http://www.ietf.org/internet-
drafts/draft-brown-xml-dsig-00.txt and discussion on
IETF Trade WG
David Burdett et al. [Page 302]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
15. Author's Address
The author of this document is:
David Burdett
Development Director
Mondex International Ltd
Advanced Technology Division
111 Pine St
San Francisco, 94111
California
USA
Tel: +1 (415) 645 6973
Email: david.burdett@mondex.com
The author of this document appreciates the following contributors to
this protocol (in alphabetic order of company) without which it could
not have been developed.
o Phillip Mullarkey, British Telecom plc
o Andrew Marchewka, Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce
o Brian Boesch, CyberCash Inc.
o Donald Eastlake 3rd, CyberCash Inc.
o Mark Linehan, International Business Machines
o Richard Brown, GlobeSet Inc.
o Peter Chang, Hewlett Packard
o Masaaki Hiroya, Hitachi Ltd
o Yoshiaki Kawatsura, Hitachi Ltd
o Jonathan Sowler, JCP Computer Services Ltd
o John Wankmueller, MasterCard International
o Steve Fabes, Mondex International Ltd
David Burdett et al. [Page 303]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Surendra Reddy, Oracle Corporation
o Akihiro Nakano, Plat Home, Inc. (ex Hitachi Ltd)
o Chris Smith, Royal Bank of Canada
o Hans Bernhard-Beykirch, SIZ (IT Development and Coordination
Centre of the German Savings Banks Organisation)
o W. Reid Carlisle, Spyrus (ex Citibank Universal Card Services,
formally AT&T Universal Card Services)
o Efrem Lipkin, Sun Microsystems
o Terry Allen, Commerce One (formally Veo Systems)
The author would also like to thank the following organisations for
their support:
o Amino Communications
o DigiCash
o Fujitsu
o General Information Systems
o Globe Id Software
o Hyperion
o InterTrader
o Nobil I T Corp
o Mercantec
o Netscape
o Nippon Telegraph and Telephone Corporation
o Oracle Corporation
o Smart Card Integrations Ltd.
o Spyrus
David Burdett et al. [Page 304]
Internet Draft IOTP/1.0 28 Feb 1999
o Verifone
o Unisource nv
o Wells Fargo Bank
File name: draft-ietf-trade-iotp-v1.0-protocol-03.txt
Expires: 28 August 1999
David Burdett et al. [Page 305]
| PAFTECH AB 2003-2026 | 2026-04-24 03:06:40 |